blob: 7007d56a5588f061bf0b49af849fb58a6440d551 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau7b66e302015-05-02 15:20:38 +02005 version 1.5.12
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7b66e302015-05-02 15:20:38 +02007 2015/05/02
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200562log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200587 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
588 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
589 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
590 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
591 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
592 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
593 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
594 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
595 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
596 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
597 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
598
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100599 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
601 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
602 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
603 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
604
605 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200606 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
607 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
608 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
609 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
610 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
611 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200613 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100615log-send-hostname [<string>]
616 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
617 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
618 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
619 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
620 the logs.
621
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000622log-tag <string>
623 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
624 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
625 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
626 running on the same host.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628nbproc <number>
629 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
630 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
631 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
632 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
633 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
634
635pidfile <pidfile>
636 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
637 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
638 starting the process. See also "daemon".
639
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200641 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
642 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
643 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
644 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
645 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
646 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100647 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200648 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
649 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100655 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
656 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
657 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
658 "bind" keyword for more information.
659
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100660ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
662 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
663 keyword to see available options.
664
665 Example:
666 global
667 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
668
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100669ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
671 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300672 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100673 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
674 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
675 information.
676
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100677ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
679 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
680 keyword to see available options.
681
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100682ssl-server-verify [none|required]
683 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
684 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
685 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
686
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200687stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
688 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
689 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
690 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
691 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
694 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
695 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200696
697stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
698 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
699 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100700 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200701
702stats maxconn <connections>
703 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
704 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706uid <number>
707 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
708 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
709 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
710 one. See also "gid" and "user".
711
712ulimit-n <number>
713 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
714 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
715 option.
716
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100717unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
718 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
719
720 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
721 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
722 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
723 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
724 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
725 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
726 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
727 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
728 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
729 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731user <user name>
732 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
733 See also "uid" and "group".
734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200735node <name>
736 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
737
738 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
739 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
740 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
741 traffic.
742
743description <text>
744 Add a text that describes the instance.
745
746 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
747 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
748 "<" and ">" characters.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752-----------------------
753
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200754max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
755 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
756 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
757 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
758 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
759 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
760 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
761 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
762 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764maxconn <number>
765 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
766 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
767 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200768 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
769 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
770 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
771 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
772 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200774maxconnrate <number>
775 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
776 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
777 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
778 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
779 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
780 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
781 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
782 fairness.
783
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100784maxcomprate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300786 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100787 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
788 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
789 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
790 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
791 default value.
792
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100793maxcompcpuusage <number>
794 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
795 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
796 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
797 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
798 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
799 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
800 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
801 process down and from introducing high latencies.
802
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100803maxpipes <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
805 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
806 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
807 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
808 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
809 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
810
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200811maxsessrate <number>
812 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
813 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
814 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
815 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
816 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
817 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
818 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
819 fairness.
820
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200821maxsslconn <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
823 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
824 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
825 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
826 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
827 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
828 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
829
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200830maxsslrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
832 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
833 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
834 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
835 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
836 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
837 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
838 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
839 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
840 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
841
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100842maxzlibmem <number>
843 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
844 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
845 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100846 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
847 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
848 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850noepoll
851 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
852 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100853 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854
855nokqueue
856 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
857 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
858 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
859
860nopoll
861 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
862 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100863 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100864 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200865
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100866nosplice
867 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
868 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
869 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100870 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100871 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
872 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
873 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
874 "option splice-response".
875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300876nogetaddrinfo
877 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
878 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
879
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200880spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900881 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
882 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
883 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
884 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
885 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
886 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200887
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200888tune.bufsize <number>
889 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
890 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
891 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
892 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
893 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
894 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
895 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
896 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400897 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
898 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
899 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200900
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200901tune.chksize <number>
902 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
903 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
904 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
905 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
906 checks whenever possible.
907
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100908tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
909 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
910 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
911 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
912 this value. The default value is 1.
913
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100914tune.http.cookielen <number>
915 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
916 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
917 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
918 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
919 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
920 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
921 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
922 to change this value.
923
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200924tune.http.maxhdr <number>
925 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
926 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
927 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
928 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
929 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
930 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
931 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
932 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
933 limit too high.
934
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100935tune.idletimer <timeout>
936 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
937 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
938 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
939 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
940 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
941 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
942 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
943 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
944 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
945
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100946tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100947 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
948 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
949 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
950 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
951 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
952 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
953 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
954 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
955 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
956 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100957
958tune.maxpollevents <number>
959 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
960 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
961 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
962 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
963 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
964
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200965tune.maxrewrite <number>
966 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
967 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
968 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
969 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
970 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
971 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
972 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
973 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
974 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
975 bufsize.
976
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200977tune.pipesize <number>
978 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
979 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
980 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
981 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
982 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
983 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
984
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100985tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
986tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
987 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
988 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
989 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
990 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
991 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
992 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
993 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
994
995tune.sndbuf.client <number>
996tune.sndbuf.server <number>
997 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
998 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
999 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1000 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1001 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1002 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1003 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1004 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1005 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1006 notifying haproxy again.
1007
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001009 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1010 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1011 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001012 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001013 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1014 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1015 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1016 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1017 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001018 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1019 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001020
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001021tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1022 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1023 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1024 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1025 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1026 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1027 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1028
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001029tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1030 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001031 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001032 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1033 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1034 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1035 being used for too long.
1036
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001037tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1038 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1039 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1040 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1041 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1042 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1043 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1044 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1045 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1046 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1047 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001048 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1049 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001050
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001051tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1052 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1053 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1054 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1055 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1056 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1057 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1058 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1059 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1060
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001061tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1062 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001063 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001064 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1065 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1066 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1067
1068tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1069 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1070 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1071 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1072 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010743.3. Debugging
1075--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077debug
1078 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1079 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1080 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1081 system startup.
1082
1083quiet
1084 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1085 line argument "-q".
1086
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010883.4. Userlists
1089--------------
1090It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1091http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1092it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1093
1094userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001095 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001096 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1097
1098group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001100 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1101 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1102
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001103user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1104 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001105 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1106 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001107 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1108 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001110 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111
1112
1113 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L1
1115 group G1 users tiger,scott
1116 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001122 userlist L2
1123 group G1
1124 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001125
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001126 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1127 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1128 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001129
1130 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001132
11333.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001134----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1136haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1137pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1138identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1139or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1140Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1141known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1142the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1143process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1144during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1145tables.
1146
1147peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001148 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001149 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1150
Willy Tarreau34d05b02015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001151disabled
1152 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1153 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1154 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1155
1156enable
1157 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1158
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001159peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1160 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1161 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1162 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1163 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1164 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1165 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1166
1167 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1168 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1169
1170 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1171 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1172 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1173 across all peers.
1174
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001175 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1176 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1177 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1178
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001179 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001180 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001181 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1182 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1183 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001184
1185 backend mybackend
1186 mode tcp
1187 balance roundrobin
1188 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1189 stick on src
1190
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001191 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1192 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001193
1194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011954. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001196----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001197
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001198Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1199 - defaults <name>
1200 - frontend <name>
1201 - backend <name>
1202 - listen <name>
1203
1204A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1205its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1206section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001207section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001208
1209A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1210connections.
1211
1212A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1213to forward incoming connections.
1214
1215A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1216parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001218All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1219'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1220case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1221
1222Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1223logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1224proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1225However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1226name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1227
1228Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1229and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001230bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001231protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1232modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1233arbitrary criteria.
1234
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001235In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1236a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1237the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1238
1239 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1240 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1241 between responses and new requests.
1242
1243 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1244 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1245 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1246 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1247
1248 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1249 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1250 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1251
1252 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1253 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1254 client-facing connection remains open.
1255
1256 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1257 after the end of the response.
1258
1259The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1260frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1261following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1262weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1263
1264 Backend mode
1265
1266 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1267 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1268 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1269 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1270 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1271 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1272 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1273 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1274 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1275 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1276 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1277
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001278
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012804.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1281--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001283The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1284limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1285they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1286limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001287marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001288option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001289and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1290with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1291specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001292
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001293
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001294 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1295------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1296acl - X X X
1297appsession - - X X
1298backlog X X X -
1299balance X - X X
1300bind - X X -
1301bind-process X X X X
1302block - X X X
1303capture cookie - X X -
1304capture request header - X X -
1305capture response header - X X -
1306clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001307compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001308contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1309cookie X - X X
1310default-server X - X X
1311default_backend X X X -
1312description - X X X
1313disabled X X X X
1314dispatch - - X X
1315enabled X X X X
1316errorfile X X X X
1317errorloc X X X X
1318errorloc302 X X X X
1319-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1320errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001321force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001322fullconn X - X X
1323grace X X X X
1324hash-type X - X X
1325http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001326http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001327http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001328http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001329http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001330http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001331id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001332ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001333log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001334log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001335max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001336maxconn X X X -
1337mode X X X X
1338monitor fail - X X -
1339monitor-net X X X -
1340monitor-uri X X X -
1341option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1342option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1343option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1344option allbackups (*) X - X X
1345option checkcache (*) X - X X
1346option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1347option contstats (*) X X X -
1348option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1349option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1350option forceclose (*) X X X X
1351-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1352option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreaub17e8b92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001353option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001354option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001355option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001356option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001357option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001358option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001359option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1360option httpchk X - X X
1361option httpclose (*) X X X X
1362option httplog X X X X
1363option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001364option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001365option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001366option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1367option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1368option logasap (*) X X X -
1369option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001370option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001371option nolinger (*) X X X X
1372option originalto X X X X
1373option persist (*) X - X X
1374option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001375option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376option smtpchk X - X X
1377option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1378option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1379option splice-request (*) X X X X
1380option splice-response (*) X X X X
1381option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1382option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1383-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001384option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001385option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1386option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1387option tcpka X X X X
1388option tcplog X X X X
1389option transparent (*) X - X X
1390persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1391rate-limit sessions X X X -
1392redirect - X X X
1393redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1394redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1395reqadd - X X X
1396reqallow - X X X
1397reqdel - X X X
1398reqdeny - X X X
1399reqiallow - X X X
1400reqidel - X X X
1401reqideny - X X X
1402reqipass - X X X
1403reqirep - X X X
1404reqisetbe - X X X
1405reqitarpit - X X X
1406reqpass - X X X
1407reqrep - X X X
1408-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1409reqsetbe - X X X
1410reqtarpit - X X X
1411retries X - X X
1412rspadd - X X X
1413rspdel - X X X
1414rspdeny - X X X
1415rspidel - X X X
1416rspideny - X X X
1417rspirep - X X X
1418rsprep - X X X
1419server - - X X
1420source X - X X
1421srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001422stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001423stats auth X - X X
1424stats enable X - X X
1425stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001426stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001427stats realm X - X X
1428stats refresh X - X X
1429stats scope X - X X
1430stats show-desc X - X X
1431stats show-legends X - X X
1432stats show-node X - X X
1433stats uri X - X X
1434-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1435stick match - - X X
1436stick on - - X X
1437stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001438stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001439stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001440tcp-check connect - - X X
1441tcp-check expect - - X X
1442tcp-check send - - X X
1443tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001444tcp-request connection - X X -
1445tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001446tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001447tcp-response content - - X X
1448tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001449timeout check X - X X
1450timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001451timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001452timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1453timeout connect X - X X
1454timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1455timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1456timeout http-request X X X X
1457timeout queue X - X X
1458timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001459timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001460timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1461timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001462timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001463transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001464unique-id-format X X X -
1465unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001466use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001467use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001468------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1469 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014724.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1473---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474
1475This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1476
1477
1478acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1479 Declare or complete an access list.
1480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1481 no | yes | yes | yes
1482 Example:
1483 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1484 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1485 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001487 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001488
1489
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001490appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1491 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001492 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1494 no | no | yes | yes
1495 Arguments :
1496 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1497 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1498
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001499 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001500 checked in each cookie value.
1501
1502 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1503 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1504 milliseconds.
1505
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001506 request-learn
1507 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1508 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1509 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1510 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1511 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1512 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1513
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001514 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1515 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1516 data following this prefix.
1517
1518 Example :
1519 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1520
1521 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1522 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1523
1524 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1525 2 modes are currently supported :
1526 - path-parameters :
1527 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1528 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1529 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1530 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1531 - query-string :
1532 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1533 query string.
1534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001535 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1536 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1537 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1538 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001539 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1540 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1541 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001542 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1543 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1544
1545 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1546
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001547 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1548 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1549 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1550
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001551 Example :
1552 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1553
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001554 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1555 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001556
1557
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001558backlog <conns>
1559 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1561 yes | yes | yes | no
1562 Arguments :
1563 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1564 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001565 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001566
1567 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1568 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1569 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1570 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1571 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1572 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1573 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1574 backlog parameter.
1575
1576 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1577 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1578 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1579
1580 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1581
1582
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001583balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001584balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001585 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1587 yes | no | yes | yes
1588 Arguments :
1589 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1590 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1591 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1592 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1593
1594 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1595 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1596 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1597 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001598 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001599 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001600 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1601 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1602 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1603 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1604 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1605 it, so that you don't worry.
1606
1607 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1608 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1609 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1610 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1611 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1612 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1613 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1614 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001616 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1617 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1618 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1619 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1620 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1621 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1622 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1623 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1624
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001625 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001626 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001627 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1628 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001629 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001630 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1631 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1632 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1633 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1634 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001635 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1636 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1637 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1638 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1639 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1640 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001641
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1643 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1644 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1645 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1646 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1647 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1648 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1649 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001650 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001651 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001652 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1653 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1654 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001655
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001656 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1657 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1658 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1659 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1660 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1661 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1662 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1663 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1664 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1665 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1666 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1667 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001668
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001669 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001670 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1671 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1672 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1673 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1674 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1675 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1676 URIs start with a leading "/".
1677
1678 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1679 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1680 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1681 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001683 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001684 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1685
1686 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001687 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1688 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001689 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1690 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1691 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1692 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001693 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001694 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1695 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001696
1697 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1698 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1699 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1700 server will receive the request.
1701
1702 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1703 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1704 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1705 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1706 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001707 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1708 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1709 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001710
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001711 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1712 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1713 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1714 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1715 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001717 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001718 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1719 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1720 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1721
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001722 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1723 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1724 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1725
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001726 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001727 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001728 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1729 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1730 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1731 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1732 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1733 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001734 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001735 used instead.
1736
1737 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1738 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1739 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1740 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1741
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001742 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1743 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1744 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1745
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001746 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001747
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001749 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1750 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001751
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001752 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1753 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1754 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001755
1756 Examples :
1757 balance roundrobin
1758 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001759 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001760 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1761 balance hdr(host)
1762 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001763
1764 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1765 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001767 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001768 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1769 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1770 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1771 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1772
1773 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1774 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1775 defaults to 16 kB.
1776
1777 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1778 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1779
1780 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1781 Round Robin.
1782
1783 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1784 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1785 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1786 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1787
1788 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1789
1790 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001791 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001792 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1793 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1794 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001796 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1797 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798
1799
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001800bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1801bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001802 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1804 no | yes | yes | no
1805 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001806 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1807 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1808 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1809 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001810 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001811 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1812 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1813 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1814 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1815 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1816 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1817 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaub4fca5d2014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001818 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1819 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1820 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1821 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1822 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1823 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1824 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001825 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1826 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1827 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001828 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1829 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1830 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1831 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001832
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001833 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1834 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001835 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1836 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1837 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001838 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1839 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1840 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1841 the range.
1842
1843 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1844 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1845 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1846 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1847 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1848 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1849 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001850 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001851 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001852
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001853 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1854 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1855 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1856 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1857 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1858 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1859 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1860 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1861
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001862 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1863 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1864 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1865 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001867 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1868 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1869 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1870 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1871 in a frontend.
1872
1873 Example :
1874 listen http_proxy
1875 bind :80,:443
1876 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001877 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001878
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001879 listen http_https_proxy
1880 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001881 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001882
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001883 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1884 bind ipv6@:80
1885 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1886 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1887
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001888 listen external_bind_app1
1889 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1890
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001891 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001892 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001893
1894
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001895bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001896 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1898 yes | yes | yes | yes
1899 Arguments :
1900 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1901 may be used to override a default value.
1902
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001903 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001904 option may be combined with other numbers.
1905
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001906 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001907 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1908 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1909 missing from all processes.
1910
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001911 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001912 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001913 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1914 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1915 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1916 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001917
1918 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1919 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1920 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1921 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1922 and 'even' instances.
1923
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001924 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1925 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1926 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1927 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001928
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001929 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1930 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1931
Willy Tarreaue56c4f12014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001932 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1933 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1934 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1935
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001936 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1937 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1938
1939 Example :
1940 listen app_ip1
1941 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001942 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001943
1944 listen app_ip2
1945 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001946 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001947
1948 listen management
1949 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001950 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001951
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001952 listen management
1953 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1954 bind-process 1-4
1955
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001956 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001957
1958
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959block { if | unless } <condition>
1960 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1962 no | yes | yes | yes
1963
1964 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1965 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001966 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001967 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001968 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1969 "block" statements per instance.
1970
1971 Example:
1972 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1973 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1974 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1975 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001977 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001978
1979
1980capture cookie <name> len <length>
1981 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1983 no | yes | yes | no
1984 Arguments :
1985 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1986 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1987 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1988 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1989 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1990
1991 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1992 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1993 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1994 right if it exceeds <length>.
1995
1996 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1997 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1998 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1999 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2000
2001 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2002 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2003 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2004
2005 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2006 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2007 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002008 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2009 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2010 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011
2012 Example:
2013 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2014
2015 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002016 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017
2018
2019capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002020 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2022 no | yes | yes | no
2023 Arguments :
2024 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002025 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2027 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2028 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2029
2030 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2031 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2032 it exceeds <length>.
2033
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002034 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2036 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002037 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2038 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2039 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2040 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002041 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002042 environments to find where the request came from.
2043
2044 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2045 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2046 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2047 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002048
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002049 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2050 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2051 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2052 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2053 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054
2055 Example:
2056 capture request header Host len 15
2057 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2058 capture request header Referrer len 15
2059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002060 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061 about logging.
2062
2063
2064capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002065 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2067 no | yes | yes | no
2068 Arguments :
2069 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002070 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2072 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2073 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2074
2075 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2076 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2077 it exceeds <length>.
2078
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002079 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002080 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2081 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2082 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002083 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2084 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2085 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2086 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002087
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002088 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2089 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2090 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2091 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2092 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093
2094 Example:
2095 capture response header Content-length len 9
2096 capture response header Location len 15
2097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002098 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002099 about logging.
2100
2101
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002102clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002103 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2105 yes | yes | yes | no
2106 Arguments :
2107 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2108 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2109 as explained at the top of this document.
2110
2111 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2112 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2113 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2114 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2115 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2116 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2117 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2118 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002119 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002120 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2121 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2122
2123 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2124 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2125 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2126 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2127 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2128 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2129
2130 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2131 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2132
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002133 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2134 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002135
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002136compression algo <algorithm> ...
2137compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002138compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002139 Enable HTTP compression.
2140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2141 yes | yes | yes | yes
2142 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002143 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2144 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2145 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2146
2147 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002148 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002149 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2150 data.
2151
2152 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2153 support for zlib was built in.
2154
2155 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2156 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2157 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2158 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2159 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2160 in.
2161
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002162 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002163 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002164 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2165 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2166 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2167 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2168 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002169
2170 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2171 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2172 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2173 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2174 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002175 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2176 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2177 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2178 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2179 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreau4cf57af2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002180 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2181 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002182
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002183 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002184 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2185 "Accept-Encoding" header
2186 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002187 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002188 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2189 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002190 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2191 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2192 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2193 "multipart"
2194 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2195 header
2196 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2197 and later
2198 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2199 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002200
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002201 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2202 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002203
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002204 Examples :
2205 compression algo gzip
2206 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002208contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002209 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2211 yes | no | yes | yes
2212 Arguments :
2213 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2214 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2215 as explained at the top of this document.
2216
2217 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002218 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002219 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002220 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2221 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2222 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2223 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2224
2225 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2226 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2227 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2228 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2229 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2230 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2231
2232 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2233 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2234 instead.
2235
2236 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2237 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2238
2239
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002240cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002241 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2242 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002243 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2245 yes | no | yes | yes
2246 Arguments :
2247 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2248 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2249 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2250 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2251 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2252 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2253 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2254 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2255 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2256
2257 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2258 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2259 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2260 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2261 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2262 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2263 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2264 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2265 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2266 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2267 "insert" and "prefix".
2268
2269 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002270 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002271
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002272 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002273 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2274 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2275 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2276 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2277 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2278 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2279 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2280 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2281 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2282 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002283
2284 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2285 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2286 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2287 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2288 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2289 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2290 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2291 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2292 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2293 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002294 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2295 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2296 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002297
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002298 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2299 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2300 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002301 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2302 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2303 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2304 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002305 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2306 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2307 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002308
2309 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2310 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2311 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2312 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2313 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2314 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2315 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2316 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2317 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2318
2319 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2320 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2321 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2322 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2323 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2324 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2325 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2326 persistence cookie in the cache.
2327 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2328
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002329 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2330 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2331 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2332 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2333 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2334 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2335 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2336 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2337 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2338 they logout.
2339
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002340 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2341 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2342 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2343 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2344
2345 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2346 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2347 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2348 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2349 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2350 this attribute.
2351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002352 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002353 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002354 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2355 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2356 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2357 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2358 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2359 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002360
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002361 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2362 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2363 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2364 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2365 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2366 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2367 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2368 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2369 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2370 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2371 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2372 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2373 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2374 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2375 the site.
2376
2377 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2378 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2379 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2380 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2381 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2382 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2383 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2384 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2385 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2386 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2387 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2388 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2389 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2390 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2391 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2392 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002394 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2395 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2396 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2397 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399 Examples :
2400 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2401 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2402 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002403 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002405 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002406 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002408
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002409default-server [param*]
2410 Change default options for a server in a backend
2411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2412 yes | no | yes | yes
2413 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002414 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2415 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2416 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2417 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002418
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002419 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002420 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2421
2422 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002424
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002425default_backend <backend>
2426 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2428 yes | yes | yes | no
2429 Arguments :
2430 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2431
2432 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2433 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2434 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2435 will catch all undetermined requests.
2436
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002437 Example :
2438
2439 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2440 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2441 default_backend dynamic
2442
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002443 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2444
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002445
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002446description <string>
2447 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2449 no | yes | yes | yes
2450 Arguments : string
2451
2452 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2453 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2454 it describes.
2455 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2456
2457
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458disabled
2459 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2461 yes | yes | yes | yes
2462 Arguments : none
2463
2464 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2465 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2466 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2467 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2468 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2469 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2470 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2471
2472 See also : "enabled"
2473
2474
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002475dispatch <address>:<port>
2476 Set a default server address
2477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2478 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002479 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002480
2481 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2482 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2483 during start-up.
2484
2485 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2486 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2487 possible with normal servers.
2488
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002489 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002490 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2491 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2492 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2493 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2494
2495 See also : "server"
2496
2497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002498enabled
2499 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2501 yes | yes | yes | yes
2502 Arguments : none
2503
2504 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2505 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2506
2507 See also : "disabled"
2508
2509
2510errorfile <code> <file>
2511 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2513 yes | yes | yes | yes
2514 Arguments :
2515 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002516 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002517
2518 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002519 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002520 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002521 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2522 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523
2524 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2525 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2526 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2527
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002528 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2529
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002530 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2531 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2532 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2533 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2534
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002535 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2536 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2537 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2538 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2539 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2540 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2543 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2544 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002545 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2547
2548 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2549
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002550 Example :
2551 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002552 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002553 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2554 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2555
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002556
2557errorloc <code> <url>
2558errorloc302 <code> <url>
2559 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2561 yes | yes | yes | yes
2562 Arguments :
2563 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002564 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002565
2566 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2567 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2568 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2569 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2570 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2571
2572 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2573 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2574 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2575
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002576 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2577
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002578 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2579 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2580 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2581 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2582 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2583 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2584 request.
2585
2586 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2587
2588
2589errorloc303 <code> <url>
2590 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2592 yes | yes | yes | yes
2593 Arguments :
2594 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2595 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2596
2597 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2598 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2599 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2600 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2601 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2602
2603 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2604 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2605 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2606
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002607 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2608
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002609 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2610 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2611 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2612 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002613 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002614
2615 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2616
2617
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002618force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2619 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2620 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2621 no | yes | yes | yes
2622
2623 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2624 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2625 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2626 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2627 marked down for maintenance operations.
2628
2629 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2630 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2631 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2632 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2633 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2634 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2635 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2636 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2637 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2638
2639 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2640 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2641 is used.
2642
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002643 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002644 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002645
2646
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002647fullconn <conns>
2648 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2650 yes | no | yes | yes
2651 Arguments :
2652 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2653 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2654
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002655 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002656 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002657 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002658 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2659 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2660 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2661 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2662 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002663 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002664
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002665 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2666 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002667 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2668 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2669 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002670
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002671 Example :
2672 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2673 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2674 # connections.
2675 backend dynamic
2676 fullconn 10000
2677 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2678 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2679
2680 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2681
2682
2683grace <time>
2684 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002686 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002687 Arguments :
2688 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2689 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2690 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2691
2692 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2693 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002694 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002695 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2696
2697 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2698 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2699 simplify it.
2700
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002701
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002702hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002703 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2705 yes | no | yes | yes
2706 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002707 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2708 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002709
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002710 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2711 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2712 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2713 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2714 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2715 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2716 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2717 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2718 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2719 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002720
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002721 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2722 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2723 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2724 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2725 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2726 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2727 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2728 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2729 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2730 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2731 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2732 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2733 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002734 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2735 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002736
2737 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2738
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002739 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002740 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2741 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2742 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002743 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2744 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2745 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002746
2747 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2748 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002749 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2750 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2751 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2752 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2753
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002754 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2755 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2756 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2757 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2758 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2759 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2760 parameter.
2761
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002762 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2763
2764 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2765 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2766 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2767 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2768 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2769 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2770 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2771 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2772 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2773 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2774 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2775 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002776
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002777 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2778 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2779 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002780
2781 See also : "balance", "server"
2782
2783
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002784http-check disable-on-404
2785 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002787 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788 Arguments : none
2789
2790 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2791 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2792 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2793 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2794 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2795 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2796 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2797 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002798 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2799 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2800 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2801
2802 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2803
2804
2805http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002806 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002808 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002809 Arguments :
2810 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2811 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002812 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002813 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2814 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2815 details on the supported keywords.
2816
2817 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2818 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2819 with the usual backslash ('\').
2820
2821 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2822 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2823 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2824 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2825 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2826
2827 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002828 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002829 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2830 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2831 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2832
2833 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002834 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002835 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2836 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2837 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2838 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2839
2840 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002841 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002842 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2843 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2844 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2845 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2846 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2847 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2848 trace).
2849
2850 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002851 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002852 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2853 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2854 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2855 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2856 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2857 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2858
2859 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2860 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2861 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2862 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2863 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2864 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2865 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2866 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2867
Cyril Bontéa448e162015-01-30 00:07:07 +01002868 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
2869 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
2870 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
2871
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002872 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2873 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2874
2875 Examples :
2876 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002877 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002878
2879 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002880 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002881
2882 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002883 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002884
2885 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002886 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002887
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002888 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002889
2890
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002891http-check send-state
2892 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2894 yes | no | yes | yes
2895 Arguments : none
2896
2897 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2898 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2899 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2900 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2901 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2902
2903 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2904 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2905 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2906 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2907 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2908 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2909 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2910 checked in multiple backends.
2911
2912 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2913 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2914
2915 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2916 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2917 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2918 one fails.
2919
2920 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2921 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2922 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2923
2924 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2925 server's queue.
2926
2927 Example of a header received by the application server :
2928 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2929 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2930
2931 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2932
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002933http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002934 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002935 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002936 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2937 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002938 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2939 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2940 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2941 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2942 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2943 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002944 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002945 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2946
2947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2948 no | yes | yes | yes
2949
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002950 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2951 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2952 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2953 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2954 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002955
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002956 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2957 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2958 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2959
2960 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2961 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2962 are evaluated.
2963
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002964 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2965 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2966 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2967 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2968 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2969 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2970 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2971 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2972 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002973 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002974 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2975
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002976 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2977 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2978 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2979 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2980 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2981
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002982 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2983 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2984 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002985 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2986 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002987
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002988 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2989 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2990 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2991 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2992 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2993 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2994 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2995 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2996
2997 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2998 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2999 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreaufcf75d22015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003000 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3001 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003002
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003003 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3004 <name>.
3005
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003006 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3007 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3008 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3009 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3010 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3011 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3012 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3013 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3014
3015 Example:
3016
3017 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3018
3019 applied to:
3020
3021 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3022
3023 outputs:
3024
3025 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3026
3027 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3028
3029 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3030 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3031 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3032 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3033 header.
3034
3035 Example:
3036
3037 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3038
3039 applied to:
3040
3041 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3042
3043 outputs:
3044
3045 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3046
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003047 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3048 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3049 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3050 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3051 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3052 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3053 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3054 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3055
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003056 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3057 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3058 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3059 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3060 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3061 another equipment.
3062
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003063 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3064 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3065 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3066 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3067 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3068 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3069 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3070 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3071
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003072 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3073 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3074 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3075 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3076 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3077 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3078 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3079 admin privileges.
3080
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003081 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3082 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3083 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3084 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3085 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3086 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3087 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3088 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3089
3090 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3091 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3092 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3093 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3094 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3095 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3096
3097 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3098 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3099 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3100 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3101 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3102 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3103
3104 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3105 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3106 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3107 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3108 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3109 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3110 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3111 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3112 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3113
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003114 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3115
3116 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3117 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3118 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3119 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003120
3121 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003122 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3123 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3124 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003125
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003126 http-request allow if nagios
3127 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3128 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3129 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003130
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003131 Example:
3132 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003133 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003134
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003135 Example:
3136 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3137 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3138 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3139 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3140 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3141 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3142 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3143 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3144 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3145
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003146 Example:
3147 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3148 acl add path /addacl
3149 acl del path /delacl
3150
3151 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3152
3153 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3154 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3155
3156 Example:
3157 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3158 acl setmap path /setmap
3159 acl delmap path /delmap
3160
3161 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3162
3163 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3164 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3165
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003166 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3167 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003168
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003169http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003170 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003171 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3172 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003173 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3174 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3175 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3176 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3177 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3178 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003179 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003180 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3181
3182 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3183 no | yes | yes | yes
3184
3185 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3186 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3187 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3188 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3189 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3190 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3191
3192 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3193 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3194 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3195 current section.
3196
3197 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3198 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3199 rules are evaluated.
3200
3201 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3202 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3203 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3204 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3205 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3206 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3207 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3208
3209 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3210 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3211 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3212 external users.
3213
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003214 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3215 <name>.
3216
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003217 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3218 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3219 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3220 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3221 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3222 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3223 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3224 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3225
3226 Example:
3227
3228 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3229
3230 applied to:
3231
3232 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3233
3234 outputs:
3235
3236 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3237
3238 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3239
3240 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3241 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3242 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3243 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3244 header.
3245
3246 Example:
3247
3248 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3249
3250 applied to:
3251
3252 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3253
3254 outputs:
3255
3256 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3257
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003258 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3259 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3260 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3261 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3262 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3263 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3264 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3265 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3266
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003267 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3268 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3269 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3270 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3271 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3272 another equipment.
3273
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003274 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3275 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3276 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3277 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3278 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3279 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3280 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3281 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3282
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003283 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3284 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3285 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3286 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3287 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3288 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3289 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3290 admin privileges.
3291
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003292 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3293 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3294 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3295 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3296 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3297 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3298 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3299 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3300
3301 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3302 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3303 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3304 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3305 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3306 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3307
3308 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3309 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3310 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3311 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3312 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3313 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3314
3315 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3316 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3317 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3318 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3319 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3320 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3321 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3322 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3323 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3324
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003325 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3326
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003327 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003328 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3329 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3330 rules.
3331
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003332 Example:
3333 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3334
3335 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3336
3337 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3338 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3339
3340 Example:
3341 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3342
3343 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3344
3345 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3346 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3347
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003348 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3349 ACL usage.
3350
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003351
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003352http-send-name-header [<header>]
3353 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3354
3355 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3356 yes | no | yes | yes
3357
3358 Arguments :
3359
3360 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3361
3362 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3363 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3364 is added with the header string proved.
3365
3366 See also : "server"
3367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003368id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003369 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3371 no | yes | yes | yes
3372 Arguments : none
3373
3374 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3375 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3376 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003377
3378
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003379ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3380 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3381 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3382 no | yes | yes | yes
3383
3384 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3385 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3386 and running).
3387
3388 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3389 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3390 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003391 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003392 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3393
3394 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3395 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3396
3397 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3398 "unless" condition is met.
3399
3400 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3401
3402
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003403log global
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003404log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003405no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003406 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3408 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003409
3410 Prefix :
3411 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3412 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3413 prefix does not allow arguments.
3414
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003415 Arguments :
3416 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3417 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3418 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3419 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3420 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3421 parameter.
3422
3423 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3424 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3425
3426 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3427 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3428 standard syslog port).
3429
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003430 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3431 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3432 standard syslog port).
3433
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003434 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3435 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3436 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3437 appropriately writeable).
3438
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003439 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3440 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3441 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3442 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3443
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003444 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3445 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3446 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3447 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3448 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3449 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3450 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3451 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3452 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3453 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3454 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3455
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003456 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3457
3458 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3459 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3460 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3461
3462 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3463 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3464 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003465 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3466 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3467 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3468 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3469 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003470
3471 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3472
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003473 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3474 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3475 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003476
3477 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3478 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3479 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3480 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3481
3482 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3483 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003484
3485 Example :
3486 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003487 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3488 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003489 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3490
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003491
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003492log-format <string>
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003493 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3494 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3495 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003496
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003497 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3498 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3499 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3500 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3501 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003502
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003503
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003504max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3505 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3507 yes | no | yes | yes
3508
3509 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3510 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3511 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3512 servers.
3513
3514 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3515 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3516 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3517 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3518 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3519 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3520 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3521 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3522 picking a different server.
3523
3524 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3525 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3526 even if they have to be queued.
3527
3528 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3529 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3530
3531
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003532maxconn <conns>
3533 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 yes | yes | yes | no
3536 Arguments :
3537 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3538 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3539 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3540 closes.
3541
3542 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3543 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3544 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3545 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3546 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3547 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3548 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3549 properly tuned.
3550
3551 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3552 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3553 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3554
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003555 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3556
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003557 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3558
3559
3560mode { tcp|http|health }
3561 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3563 yes | yes | yes | yes
3564 Arguments :
3565 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3566 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3567 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3568 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3569
3570 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3571 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3572 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3573 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3574 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3575
3576 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003577 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3578 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3579 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3580 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3581 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3582 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3583 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003585 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3586 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3587 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003588
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003589 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003590 defaults http_instances
3591 mode http
3592
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003593 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003594
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003596monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003597 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3599 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600 Arguments :
3601 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3602 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003603 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003604 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3605 backend and its backup.
3606
3607 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3608 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3609 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3610 servers in a list of backends.
3611
3612 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3613 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3614 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3615 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3616 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3617 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3618 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003619 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3620 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621
3622 Example:
3623 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003624 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003625 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3626 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3627 monitor-uri /site_alive
3628 monitor fail if site_dead
3629
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003630 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003631
3632
3633monitor-net <source>
3634 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3636 yes | yes | yes | no
3637 Arguments :
3638 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3639 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3640 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3641 followed by a mask.
3642
3643 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3644 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003645 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003646 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3647
3648 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3649 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3650 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3651 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003652 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3653 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3654 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003655
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003656 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3657 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3658 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3659 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3660 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3661 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003662
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003663 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3664 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003665
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003666 Example :
3667 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3668 frontend www
3669 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3670
3671 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3672
3673
3674monitor-uri <uri>
3675 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3677 yes | yes | yes | no
3678 Arguments :
3679 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3680 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3681
3682 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3683 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3684 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3685 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3686 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3687 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3688 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3689 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3690
3691 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3692 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3693 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3694 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3695 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3696 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3697
3698 Example :
3699 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3700 frontend www
3701 mode http
3702 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3703
3704 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3705
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003706
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003707option abortonclose
3708no option abortonclose
3709 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3711 yes | no | yes | yes
3712 Arguments : none
3713
3714 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3715 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3716 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3717 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003718 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003719 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3720 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3721 encountered while delivering the response.
3722
3723 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3724 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3725 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3726 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3727 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3728 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003729 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003730 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003731 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003732 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3733 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3734 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3735
3736 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3737 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3738 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3739 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3740 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3741 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3742 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3743 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003744 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003745
3746 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3747 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3748
3749 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3750
3751
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003752option accept-invalid-http-request
3753no option accept-invalid-http-request
3754 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | yes | yes | no
3757 Arguments : none
3758
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003759 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003760 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3761 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3762 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3763 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3764 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3765 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3766 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003767 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3768 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3769 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3770 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3771 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003772 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
3773 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple
3774 digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003775
3776 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3777 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3778 been confirmed.
3779
3780 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3781 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003782 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3783 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003784 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3785
3786 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3787 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3788
3789 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3790 stats socket.
3791
3792
3793option accept-invalid-http-response
3794no option accept-invalid-http-response
3795 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3797 yes | no | yes | yes
3798 Arguments : none
3799
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003800 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003801 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3802 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3803 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3804 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3805 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3806 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3807 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003808 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
3809 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
3810 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003811
3812 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3813 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3814 been confirmed.
3815
3816 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3817 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3818 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3819 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3820
3821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3823
3824 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3825 stats socket.
3826
3827
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003828option allbackups
3829no option allbackups
3830 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3832 yes | no | yes | yes
3833 Arguments : none
3834
3835 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3836 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3837 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3838 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3839 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3840 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3841 order between the backup servers anymore.
3842
3843 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3844 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3845
3846 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3847 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3848
3849
3850option checkcache
3851no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003852 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3854 yes | no | yes | yes
3855 Arguments : none
3856
3857 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3858 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003859 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003860 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3861 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003862 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003863
3864 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003865 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003866 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003867 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3868 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003869 to the client are :
3870 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003871 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003872 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003873 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3874 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3875 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3876 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3877 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3878 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3879 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3880 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3881 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3882 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3883 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3884
3885 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003886 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003887 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003888 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003889 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3890
3891 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3892 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003893 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003894 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3895
3896 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3897 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3898
3899
3900option clitcpka
3901no option clitcpka
3902 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3904 yes | yes | yes | no
3905 Arguments : none
3906
3907 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3908 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3909 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3910 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3911
3912 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3913 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3914 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3915 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3916
3917 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3918 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3919 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3920 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3921 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3922
3923 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3924
3925 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3926 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3927 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3928
3929 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3930 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3931
3932 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3933
3934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003935option contstats
3936 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3938 yes | yes | yes | no
3939 Arguments : none
3940
3941 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3942 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3943 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3944 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3945 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3946 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3947 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3948
3949
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003950option dontlog-normal
3951no option dontlog-normal
3952 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3954 yes | yes | yes | no
3955 Arguments : none
3956
3957 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3958 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3959 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3960 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3961 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3962 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3963 logged.
3964
3965 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3966 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3967 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003969 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003970 logging.
3971
3972
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003973option dontlognull
3974no option dontlognull
3975 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3977 yes | yes | yes | no
3978 Arguments : none
3979
3980 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3981 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3982 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3983 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3984 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3985 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02003986 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
3987 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
3988 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003989
3990 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3991 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3992 would not be logged.
3993
3994 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3995 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3996
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02003997 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
3998 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003999
4000
4001option forceclose
4002no option forceclose
4003 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004005 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004006 Arguments : none
4007
4008 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4009 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4010 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4011 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4012 global session times in the logs.
4013
4014 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004015 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004016 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004017
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004018 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4019 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4020 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4021
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004022 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4023 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004024
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4027
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004028 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004029
4030
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004031option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004032 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4034 yes | yes | yes | yes
4035 Arguments :
4036 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4037 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004038 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004039 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004040
4041 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4042 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4043 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4044 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4045 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4046 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4047 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004048 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4049 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4050 possible that the client has already brought one.
4051
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004052 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004053 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004054 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4055 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004056 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4057 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004058
4059 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4060 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4061 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4062 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4063 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4064 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4065 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4066
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004067 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4068 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4069 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4070 are under the control of the end-user.
4071
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004072 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004073 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4074 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004075 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4076 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4077 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004078
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004079 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004080 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4081 frontend www
4082 mode http
4083 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4084
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004085 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4086 backend www
4087 mode http
4088 option forwardfor header X-Client
4089
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004090 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004091 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004092
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004093
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004094option http-ignore-probes
4095no option http-ignore-probes
4096 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 yes | yes | yes | no
4099 Arguments : none
4100
4101 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4102 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4103 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4104 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4105 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4106 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4107 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4108 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4109 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4110 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4111 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4112 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4113
4114 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4115 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4116 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4117 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4118 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4119 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4120 are often the only way to detect them.
4121
4122 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4123 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4124
4125 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4126
4127
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004128option http-keep-alive
4129no option http-keep-alive
4130 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4132 yes | yes | yes | yes
4133 Arguments : none
4134
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004135 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4136 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4137 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4138 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4139 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4140 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4141 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4142
4143 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4144 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004145 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4146 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4147 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4148 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4149 situations where this option may be useful :
4150
4151 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4152 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4153
4154 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4155 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4156
4157 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4158 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4159 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4160 request.
4161
4162 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4163 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004164 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4165 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4166 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004167
4168 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4169 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4170
4171 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4172 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4173 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4174 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4175 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4176 not set.
4177
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004178 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4179 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004180 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004181 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004182
4183 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004184 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4185 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004186
4187
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004188option http-no-delay
4189no option http-no-delay
4190 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 yes | yes | yes | yes
4193 Arguments : none
4194
4195 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4196 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4197 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4198 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4199 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4200 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4201 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4202 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4203 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4204 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4205 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4206 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4207 affected.
4208
4209 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4210 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4211 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4212 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4213 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4214 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4215 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4216 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4217 latency environments.
4218
4219
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004220option http-pretend-keepalive
4221no option http-pretend-keepalive
4222 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4224 yes | yes | yes | yes
4225 Arguments : none
4226
4227 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4228 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4229 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4230 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4231 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4232 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4233 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4234 consider the response complete.
4235
4236 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4237 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4238 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4239 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4240 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4241 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4242
4243 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4244 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4245 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4246 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4247 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4248 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4249 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4250
4251 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4252 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004253 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004254 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4255 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004256
4257 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4258 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4259
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004260 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4261 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004262
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004263
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004264option http-server-close
4265no option http-server-close
4266 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 yes | yes | yes | yes
4269 Arguments : none
4270
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004271 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4272 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4273 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4274 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4275 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4276 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4277 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4278 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4279 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4280 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4281 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4282 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4283 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4284 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4285 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4286 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004287
4288 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4289 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4290 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4291 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004292 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4293 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004294
4295 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4296 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004297 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4298 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004299 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4300 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004301
4302 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4303 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4304
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004305 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004306 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4307 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004308
4309
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004310option http-tunnel
4311no option http-tunnel
4312 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4314 yes | yes | yes | yes
4315 Arguments : none
4316
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004317 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4318 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4319 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4320 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4321 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4322 "option http-tunnel".
4323
4324 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004325 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004326 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4327 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4328 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4329 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4330 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4331 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4332 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004333
4334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4336
4337 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4338 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4339 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4340
4341
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004342option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004343no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004344 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4346 yes | yes | yes | no
4347 Arguments : none
4348
4349 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4350 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4351 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4352 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4353 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4354 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4355 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4356
4357 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4358 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4359 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4360 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4361 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4362 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4363 request along its whole life.
4364
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004365 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4366 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4367 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4368 front of an existing proxy.
4369
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004370 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4371
4372 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4373 http-server-close".
4374
4375
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004376option httpchk
4377option httpchk <uri>
4378option httpchk <method> <uri>
4379option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4380 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4382 yes | no | yes | yes
4383 Arguments :
4384 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4385 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4386 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4387 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4388 ones.
4389
4390 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4391 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4392 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4393
4394 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4395 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4396 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4397 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4398 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4399
4400 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4401 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4402 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4403 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4404 the lack of any response.
4405
4406 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4407
4408 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4409 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4410 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4411
4412 Examples :
4413 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4414 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4415 backend https_relay
4416 mode tcp
4417 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4418 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4419
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004420 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4421 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4422 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004423
4424
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004425option httpclose
4426no option httpclose
4427 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4429 yes | yes | yes | yes
4430 Arguments : none
4431
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004432 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4433 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4434 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4435 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004436 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004437 "option http-tunnel".
4438
4439 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4440 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4441 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4442 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4443 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4444 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4445 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4446 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004447
4448 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004449 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004450 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4451 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4452 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4453 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4454 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004455
4456 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4457 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004458 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4459 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004460 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4461 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004462
4463 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4464 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4465
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004466 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4467 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004468
4469
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004470option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004471 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4473 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004474 Arguments :
4475 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4476 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4477 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4478 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4479 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004480
4481 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4482 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4483 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4484 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4485 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4486 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4487 ports.
4488
4489 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4490
PiBa-NL211c2e92014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004491 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4492 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004494 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004495
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004496
4497option http_proxy
4498no option http_proxy
4499 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4501 yes | yes | yes | yes
4502 Arguments : none
4503
4504 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4505 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4506 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4507 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4508 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4509
4510 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4511 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4512 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4513 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004514 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004515 be analyzed.
4516
4517 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4518 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4519
4520 Example :
4521 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4522 backend direct_forward
4523 option httpclose
4524 option http_proxy
4525
4526 See also : "option httpclose"
4527
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004528
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004529option independent-streams
4530no option independent-streams
4531 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4533 yes | yes | yes | yes
4534 Arguments : none
4535
4536 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4537 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4538 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4539 receive data or not.
4540
4541 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4542 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4543 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4544 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4545 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4546 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4547 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4548 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4549 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4550 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4551 socket buffers.
4552
4553 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4554 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4555 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4556 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4557 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4558
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004559 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004560 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4561 deprecated.
4562
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004563 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004564
4565
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004566option ldap-check
4567 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4569 yes | no | yes | yes
4570 Arguments : none
4571
4572 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4573 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4574 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4575 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4576
4577 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4578 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4579
4580 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4581 configure it.
4582
4583 Example :
4584 option ldap-check
4585
4586 See also : "option httpchk"
4587
4588
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004589option log-health-checks
4590no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004591 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4593 yes | no | yes | yes
4594 Arguments : none
4595
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004596 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4597 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4598 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004599
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004600 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4601 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4602 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4603 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4604 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4605
4606 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4607 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004608
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004609 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4610 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4611 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004612
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004613
4614option log-separate-errors
4615no option log-separate-errors
4616 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 yes | yes | yes | no
4619 Arguments : none
4620
4621 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4622 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4623 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4624 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4625 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4626 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4627 provides very important information.
4628
4629 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4630 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4631 error logs.
4632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004633 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004634 logging.
4635
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004636
4637option logasap
4638no option logasap
4639 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4641 yes | yes | yes | no
4642 Arguments : none
4643
4644 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4645 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4646 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4647 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4648 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4649 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4650 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004651 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004652 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4653 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4654
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004655 Examples :
4656 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4657 mode http
4658 option httplog
4659 option logasap
4660 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4661
4662 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4663 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4664 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4665 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4666
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004667 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004668 logging.
4669
4670
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004671option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004672 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4674 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004675 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004676 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4677 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004678 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004679
4680 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4681 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4682 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4683 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4684 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4685 in the MySQL table, like this :
4686
4687 USE mysql;
4688 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4689 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4690
4691 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4692 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4693 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4694 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4695 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4696 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4697 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4698 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4699 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4700
4701 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4702 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004703
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004704 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004705
4706 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4707 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4708 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4709 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4710 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4711 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4712
4713 See also: "option httpchk"
4714
4715
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004716option nolinger
4717no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004718 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004719 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4720 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004721 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004722
4723 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4724 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4725 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4726 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4727 connections.
4728
4729 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4730 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4731 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4732 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4733 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4734 this too.
4735
4736 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4737 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4738 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4739
4740 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4741 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4742 for servers.
4743
4744 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4745 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4746
4747
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004748option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4749 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | yes | yes | yes
4752 Arguments :
4753 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4754 matching <network>
4755 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4756 header name.
4757
4758 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4759 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4760 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4761 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4762 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4763 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4764 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4765 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4766 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4767 possible that the client has already brought one.
4768
4769 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4770 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4771 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4772 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4773 header and requires different one.
4774
4775 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4776 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4777 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4778 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4779 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4780 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4781 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4782
4783 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4784 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4785 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4786 both are defined.
4787
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004788 Examples :
4789 # Original Destination address
4790 frontend www
4791 mode http
4792 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4793
4794 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4795 backend www
4796 mode http
4797 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4798
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004799 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4800 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004801
4802
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004803option persist
4804no option persist
4805 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4806 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004808 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004809
4810 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4811 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4812 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4813 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4814 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4815 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4816 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4817 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4818 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4819 redirected to another valid server.
4820
4821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4823
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004824 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004825
4826
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004827option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4828 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4830 yes | no | yes | yes
4831 Arguments :
4832 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4833 PostgreSQL server.
4834
4835 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4836 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4837 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4838 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4839
4840 See also: "option httpchk"
4841
4842
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004843option prefer-last-server
4844no option prefer-last-server
4845 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4847 yes | no | yes | yes
4848 Arguments : none
4849
4850 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4851 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4852 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4853 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4854 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4855 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4856 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4857 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4858 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004859 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4860 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4861 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4862 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4863 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4864 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4865 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004866
4867 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4868 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4869
4870 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4871
4872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004873option redispatch
4874no option redispatch
4875 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4877 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004878 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004879
4880 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4881 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4882 be able to access the service anymore.
4883
4884 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4885 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4886
4887 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4888 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4889 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004891 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4892 "redisp" keywords.
4893
4894 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4895 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4896
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004897 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004898
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004899
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004900option redis-check
4901 Use redis health checks for server testing
4902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4903 yes | no | yes | yes
4904 Arguments : none
4905
4906 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4907 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4908 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4909 find the "+PONG" response message.
4910
4911 Example :
4912 option redis-check
4913
4914 See also : "option httpchk"
4915
4916
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004917option smtpchk
4918option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4919 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4921 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004922 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004923 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4924 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4925 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4926
4927 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4928 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4929 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4930
4931 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4932 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4933 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4934 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4935 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4936 dead server.
4937
4938 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4939 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4940 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4941 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4942
4943 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4944 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4945 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4946 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4947 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4948
4949 Example :
4950 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4951
4952 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004955option socket-stats
4956no option socket-stats
4957
4958 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4960 yes | yes | yes | no
4961
4962 Arguments : none
4963
4964
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004965option splice-auto
4966no option splice-auto
4967 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4969 yes | yes | yes | yes
4970 Arguments : none
4971
4972 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4973 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4974 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4975 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004976 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004977 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4978 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4979 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4980 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4981
4982 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4983 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4984 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4985 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4986 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4987 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4988 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4989 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4990 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4991 keyword.
4992
4993 Example :
4994 option splice-auto
4995
4996 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4997 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4998
4999 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5000 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5001
5002
5003option splice-request
5004no option splice-request
5005 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5007 yes | yes | yes | yes
5008 Arguments : none
5009
5010 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005011 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005012 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5013 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5014 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5015 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5016
5017 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5018
5019 Example :
5020 option splice-request
5021
5022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5024
5025 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5026 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5027
5028
5029option splice-response
5030no option splice-response
5031 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5033 yes | yes | yes | yes
5034 Arguments : none
5035
5036 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005037 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005038 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5039 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5040 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5041 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5042
5043 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5044
5045 Example :
5046 option splice-response
5047
5048 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5049 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5050
5051 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5052 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5053
5054
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005055option srvtcpka
5056no option srvtcpka
5057 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5059 yes | no | yes | yes
5060 Arguments : none
5061
5062 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5063 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5064 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5065 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5066
5067 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5068 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5069 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5070 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5071
5072 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5073 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5074 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5075 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5076 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5077
5078 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5079
5080 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5081 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5082 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5083
5084 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5085 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5086
5087 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5088
5089
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005090option ssl-hello-chk
5091 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5093 yes | no | yes | yes
5094 Arguments : none
5095
5096 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5097 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5098 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5099 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5100 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5101 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5102 hello message.
5103
5104 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5105 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5106 messages, which is appreciable.
5107
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005108 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5109 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5110 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005111
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005112 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5113
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005114
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005115option tcp-check
5116 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5117 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5118 yes | no | yes | yes
5119
5120 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5121 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5122
5123 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5124 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5125 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5126
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005127 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005128 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5129 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5130 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5131 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5132 only.
5133
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005134 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005135 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5136 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5137 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5138 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5139
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005140 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005141 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5142 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005143 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005144 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5145 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5146 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5147 the respective protocols.
5148 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5149 analysed.
5150
5151 Examples :
5152 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5153 option tcp-check
5154 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5155
5156 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5157 option tcp-check
5158 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5159
5160 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5161 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005162 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005163 option tcp-check
5164 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5165 tcp-check expect +PONG
5166 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5167 tcp-check expect string role:master
5168 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5169 tcp-check expect string +OK
5170
5171 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5172 (send many headers before analyzing)
5173 option tcp-check
5174 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5175 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5176 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5177 tcp-check send \r\n
5178 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5179
5180
5181 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5182
5183
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005184option tcp-smart-accept
5185no option tcp-smart-accept
5186 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5188 yes | yes | yes | no
5189 Arguments : none
5190
5191 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5192 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5193 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5194 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5195 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5196 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5197
5198 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5199 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5200 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5201 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5202
5203 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5204 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5205 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5206 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5207
5208 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5209 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5210 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5211
5212 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5213 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5214 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5215
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005216 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5217
5218
5219option tcp-smart-connect
5220no option tcp-smart-connect
5221 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5223 yes | no | yes | yes
5224 Arguments : none
5225
5226 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5227 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5228 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5229 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5230 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5231
5232 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5233 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5234 complex.
5235
5236 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5237 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5238 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5239
5240 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5241 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5242
5243 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5244
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005245
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005246option tcpka
5247 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5249 yes | yes | yes | yes
5250 Arguments : none
5251
5252 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5253 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5254 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5255 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5256
5257 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5258 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5259 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5260 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5261
5262 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5263 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5264 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5265 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5266 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5267
5268 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5269
5270 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5271 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5272 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5273 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5274 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5275 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5276 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5277 backends.
5278
5279 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5280
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005281
5282option tcplog
5283 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5285 yes | yes | yes | yes
5286 Arguments : none
5287
5288 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5289 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5290 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5291 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5292 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5293 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5294 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5295 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5296
5297 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005299 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005300
5301
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005302option transparent
5303no option transparent
5304 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005306 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005307 Arguments : none
5308
5309 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5310 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5311 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5312 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5313 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5314 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5315 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5316 appropriate server.
5317
5318 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5319 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5320
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005321 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005322 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005323
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005324
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005325persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005326persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005327 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 yes | no | yes | yes
5330 Arguments :
5331 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005332 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5333 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005334
5335 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5336 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5337 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5338 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5339 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5340 forwarded to this server.
5341
5342 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5343 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5344 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005345 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005346 a single "listen" section.
5347
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005348 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5349 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5350 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5351
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005352 Example :
5353 listen tse-farm
5354 bind :3389
5355 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5356 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5357 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5358 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5359 persist rdp-cookie
5360 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005361 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005362 balance rdp-cookie
5363 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5364 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5365
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005366 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5367 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005368
5369
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005370rate-limit sessions <rate>
5371 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5373 yes | yes | yes | no
5374 Arguments :
5375 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5376 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5377
5378 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5379 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5380 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5381 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5382 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5383 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5384
5385 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5386 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5387 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5388 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5389
5390 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5391 listen smtp
5392 mode tcp
5393 bind :25
5394 rate-limit sessions 10
5395 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5396
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005397 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5398 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5399 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005400
5401 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5402
5403
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005404redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5405redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5406redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005407 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5409 no | yes | yes | yes
5410
5411 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005412 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005413
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005414 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005415 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005416 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5417 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5418 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005419
5420 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5421 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5422 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5423 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5424 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005425 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5426 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5427 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5428 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005429
5430 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5431 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5432 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5433 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5434 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5435 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005436 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005437 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005438 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5439 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5440 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005441
5442 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005443 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5444 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5445 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5446 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5447 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5448 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5449 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5450 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005451
5452 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5453 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5454
5455 - "drop-query"
5456 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5457 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5458 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5459 with a location-type redirect.
5460
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005461 - "append-slash"
5462 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5463 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5464 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5465 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5466
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005467 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5468 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5469 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5470 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5471 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5472 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5473 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5474
5475 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5476 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5477 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5478 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5479 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5480 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5481 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005482
5483 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5484 acl clear dst_port 80
5485 acl secure dst_port 8080
5486 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005487 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005488 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005489 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5490
5491 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005492 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5493 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5494 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005495 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005496
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005497 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5498 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5499 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5500
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005501 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005502 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005503
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005504 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5505 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5506 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005508 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005509
5510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005511redisp (deprecated)
5512redispatch (deprecated)
5513 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5515 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005516 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005517
5518 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5519 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5520 be able to access the service anymore.
5521
5522 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5523 redistribute them to a working server.
5524
5525 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5526 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5527 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005528
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005529 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5530 "option redispatch" instead.
5531
5532 See also : "option redispatch"
5533
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005534
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005535reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005536 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5538 no | yes | yes | yes
5539 Arguments :
5540 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5541 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005542 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005543
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005544 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5545 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5546
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005547 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5548 the last header of an HTTP request.
5549
5550 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5551 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5552 responses.
5553
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005554 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5555 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5556 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5557
5558 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5559 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005560
5561
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005562reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5563reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005564 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5566 no | yes | yes | yes
5567 Arguments :
5568 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5569 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5570 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5571 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5572 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5573 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5574 ignores case.
5575
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005576 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5577 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5578
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005579 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5580 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5581 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5582 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005583 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005584
5585 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5586 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5587
5588 Example :
5589 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5590 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5591 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5592
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005593 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5594 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005595
5596
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005597reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5598reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005599 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5601 no | yes | yes | yes
5602 Arguments :
5603 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5604 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5605 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5606 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5607 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5608 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5609
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005610 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5611 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5612
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005613 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5614 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5615 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5616 next servers.
5617
5618 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5619 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5620 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5621
5622 Example :
5623 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5624 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5625 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5626
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005627 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5628 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005629
5630
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005631reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5632reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005633 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5635 no | yes | yes | yes
5636 Arguments :
5637 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5638 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5639 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5640 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5641 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5642 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5643 case.
5644
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005645 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5646 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5647
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005648 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5649 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5650 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5651 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005652 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005653
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005654 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005655 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005656 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005657
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005658 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5659 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5660
5661 Example :
5662 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5663 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5664 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5665
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005666 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5667 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005668
5669
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005670reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5671reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005672 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5674 no | yes | yes | yes
5675 Arguments :
5676 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5677 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5678 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5679 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5680 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5681 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5682 case.
5683
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005684 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5685 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5686
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005687 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5688 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5689 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5690 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5691
5692 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5693 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5694
5695 Example :
5696 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5697 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5698 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5699 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5700
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005701 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5702 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005703
5704
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005705reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5706reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005707 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5709 no | yes | yes | yes
5710 Arguments :
5711 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5712 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5713 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5714 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5715 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5716 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5717
5718 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5719 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5720 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5721 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005722 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005723
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005724 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5725 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5726
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005727 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5728 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5729 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5730
5731 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5732 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5733 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5734 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5735 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5736
5737 Example :
5738 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005739 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005740 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5741 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5742
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005743 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5744 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005745
5746
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005747reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5748reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005749 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5751 no | yes | yes | yes
5752 Arguments :
5753 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5754 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5755 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5756 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5757 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5758 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5759 ignores case.
5760
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005761 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5762 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5763
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005764 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5765 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005766 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5767 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5768 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005769 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5770 not set.
5771
5772 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5773 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5774 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5775 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5776 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5777
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005778 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005779 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5780 # block all others.
5781 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5782 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5783
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005784 # block bad guys
5785 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5786 reqitarpit . if badguys
5787
5788 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5789 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005790
5791
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005792retries <value>
5793 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5795 yes | no | yes | yes
5796 Arguments :
5797 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5798 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5799 default value is 3.
5800
5801 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5802 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5803 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5804
5805 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5806 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5807
5808 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5809 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5810
5811 See also : "option redispatch"
5812
5813
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005814rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005815 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5817 no | yes | yes | yes
5818 Arguments :
5819 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5820 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005821 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005822
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005823 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5824 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5825
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005826 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5827 the last header of an HTTP response.
5828
5829 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5830 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5831 responses.
5832
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005833 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5834 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005835
5836
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005837rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5838rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005839 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5841 no | yes | yes | yes
5842 Arguments :
5843 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5844 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5845 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5846 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5847 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5848 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5849 ignores case.
5850
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005851 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5852 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5853
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005854 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5855 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005856 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005857 client.
5858
5859 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5860 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5861 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5862
5863 Example :
5864 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005865 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005866
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005867 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5868 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005869
5870
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005871rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5872rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005873 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5875 no | yes | yes | yes
5876 Arguments :
5877 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5878 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5879 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5880 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5881 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5882 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5883 ignores case.
5884
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005885 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5886 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5887
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005888 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5889 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5890 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5891 case-sensitive.
5892
5893 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005894 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5895 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5896 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005897
5898 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5899 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5900
5901 Example :
5902 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5903 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5904
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005905 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5906 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005907
5908
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005909rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5910rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005911 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5913 no | yes | yes | yes
5914 Arguments :
5915 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5916 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5917 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5918 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5919 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5920 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5921 ignores case.
5922
5923 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5924 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5925 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5926 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005927 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005928
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005929 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5930 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5931
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005932 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5933 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5934 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5935
5936 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5937 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5938 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5939 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5940 are not case-sensitive.
5941
5942 Example :
5943 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5944 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5945
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005946 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5947 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005948
5949
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005950server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005951 Declare a server in a backend
5952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5953 no | no | yes | yes
5954 Arguments :
5955 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005956 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005957 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005958
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005959 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5960 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5961 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5962 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005963 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5964 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5965 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5966 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5967 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005968 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5969 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5970 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5971 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5972 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5973 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5974 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005975 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005976 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5977 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5978 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5979 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005980
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005981 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005982 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5983 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5984 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5985 adding this value to the client's port.
5986
5987 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5988 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005989 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005990
5991 Examples :
5992 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5993 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005994 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005995 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5996 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5997 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005998
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005999 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6000 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006001
6002
6003source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006004source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006005source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006006 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 yes | no | yes | yes
6009 Arguments :
6010 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6011 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006012
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006013 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006014 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6015 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6016 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6017 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6018 supported prefixes are :
6019 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6020 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6021 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006022 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006023 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6024 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6025 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6026 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006027
6028 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6029 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006030 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6031 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6032 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006033
6034 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6035 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6036 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6037 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6038 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6039 <addr>.
6040
6041 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6042 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6043 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6044 port.
6045
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006046 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6047 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6048 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6049 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006050 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006051 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6052 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6053 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6054 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6055 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6056 HTTP header.
6057
6058 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6059 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006060 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006061 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6062 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6063 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6064 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6065 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6066 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6067 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6068
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006069 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6070 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6071 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6072 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6073 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6074 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6075
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006076 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6077 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6078 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6079 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6080
6081 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6082 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6083 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6084 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6085 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6086 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6087
6088 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6089 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6090 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6091 there are two methods :
6092
6093 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6094 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6095 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6096 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6097 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6098 of the client ranges may be used.
6099
6100 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6101 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6102 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6103 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6104 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6105 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6106 same session.
6107
6108 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6109 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6110 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6111 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6112 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6113 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6114
6115 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6116 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6117 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006118 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006119
6120 Examples :
6121 backend private
6122 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6123 source 192.168.1.200
6124
6125 backend transparent_ssl1
6126 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6127 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6128
6129 backend transparent_ssl2
6130 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6131 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6132 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6133
6134 backend transparent_ssl3
6135 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6136 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6137 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6138
6139 backend transparent_smtp
6140 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6141 # with Tproxy version 4.
6142 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6143
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006144 backend transparent_http
6145 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6146 # proxy.
6147 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006149 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006150 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006152
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006153srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6154 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6156 yes | no | yes | yes
6157 Arguments :
6158 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6159 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6160 as explained at the top of this document.
6161
6162 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6163 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6164 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6165 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6166 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6167 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6168 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6169
6170 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6171 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6172 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6173 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6174 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006175 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006176 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006177 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006178
6179 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6180 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6181 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6182 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6183 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6184 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6185
6186 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6187 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6188
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006189 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6190 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006191
6192
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006193stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6194 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006196 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006197
6198 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6199 matched.
6200
6201 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6202 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6203
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006204 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6205 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6206 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6207
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006208 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6209 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6210 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6211 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006212
6213 Example :
6214 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6215 backend stats_localhost
6216 stats enable
6217 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6218
6219 Example :
6220 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6221 backend stats_auth
6222 stats enable
6223 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6224 stats admin if TRUE
6225
6226 Example :
6227 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6228 userlist stats-auth
6229 group admin users admin
6230 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6231 group readonly users haproxy
6232 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6233
6234 backend stats_auth
6235 stats enable
6236 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6237 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6238 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6239 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6240
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006241 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6242 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6243 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006244
6245
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006246stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6247 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006249 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006250 Arguments :
6251 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6252
6253 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6254
6255 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6256 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6257 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6258 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6259 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6260 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6261
6262 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6263 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6264 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006265 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006266
6267 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6268 report using "stats scope".
6269
6270 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6271 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6272 unobvious parameters.
6273
6274 Example :
6275 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6276 backend public_www
6277 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6278 stats enable
6279 stats hide-version
6280 stats scope .
6281 stats uri /admin?stats
6282 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6283 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6284 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6285
6286 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6287 backend private_monitoring
6288 stats enable
6289 stats uri /admin?stats
6290 stats refresh 5s
6291
6292 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6293
6294
6295stats enable
6296 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006298 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006299 Arguments : none
6300
6301 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6302 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6303 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6304 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6305 - stats auth : no authentication
6306 - stats scope : no restriction
6307
6308 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6309 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6310 unobvious parameters.
6311
6312 Example :
6313 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6314 backend public_www
6315 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6316 stats enable
6317 stats hide-version
6318 stats scope .
6319 stats uri /admin?stats
6320 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6321 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6322 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6323
6324 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6325 backend private_monitoring
6326 stats enable
6327 stats uri /admin?stats
6328 stats refresh 5s
6329
6330 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6331
6332
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006333stats hide-version
6334 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006336 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006337 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006338
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006339 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6340 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6341 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6342 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6343 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6344 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006346 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6347 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6348 unobvious parameters.
6349
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006350 Example :
6351 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6352 backend public_www
6353 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006354 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006355 stats hide-version
6356 stats scope .
6357 stats uri /admin?stats
6358 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6359 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6360 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006361
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006362 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6363 backend private_monitoring
6364 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006365 stats uri /admin?stats
6366 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006367
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006368 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006369
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006370
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006371stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6373 Access control for statistics
6374
6375 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6376 no | no | yes | yes
6377
6378 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6379 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6380 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6381 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6382 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6383 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6384
6385 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6386 instance.
6387
6388 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6389 about ACL usage.
6390
6391
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006392stats realm <realm>
6393 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006395 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006396 Arguments :
6397 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6398 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6399 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6400
6401 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6402 using a backslash ('\').
6403
6404 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6405 only related to authentication.
6406
6407 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6408 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6409 unobvious parameters.
6410
6411 Example :
6412 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6413 backend public_www
6414 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6415 stats enable
6416 stats hide-version
6417 stats scope .
6418 stats uri /admin?stats
6419 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6420 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6421 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6422
6423 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6424 backend private_monitoring
6425 stats enable
6426 stats uri /admin?stats
6427 stats refresh 5s
6428
6429 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6430
6431
6432stats refresh <delay>
6433 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006435 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006436 Arguments :
6437 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6438 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6439 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6440 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6441 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6442 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6443
6444 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6445 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6446 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6447 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6448
6449 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6450 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6451 unobvious parameters.
6452
6453 Example :
6454 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6455 backend public_www
6456 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6457 stats enable
6458 stats hide-version
6459 stats scope .
6460 stats uri /admin?stats
6461 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6462 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6463 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6464
6465 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6466 backend private_monitoring
6467 stats enable
6468 stats uri /admin?stats
6469 stats refresh 5s
6470
6471 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6472
6473
6474stats scope { <name> | "." }
6475 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006477 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006478 Arguments :
6479 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6480 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6481 section in which the statement appears.
6482
6483 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6484 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6485 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6486 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6487 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6488 exists.
6489
6490 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6491 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6492 unobvious parameters.
6493
6494 Example :
6495 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6496 backend public_www
6497 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6498 stats enable
6499 stats hide-version
6500 stats scope .
6501 stats uri /admin?stats
6502 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6503 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6504 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6505
6506 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6507 backend private_monitoring
6508 stats enable
6509 stats uri /admin?stats
6510 stats refresh 5s
6511
6512 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6513
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006514
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006515stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006516 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006518 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006519
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006520 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006521 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6522
6523 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6524 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6525
6526 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6527 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006528 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006529
6530 Example :
6531 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6532 backend private_monitoring
6533 stats enable
6534 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6535 stats uri /admin?stats
6536 stats refresh 5s
6537
6538 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6539 global section.
6540
6541
6542stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006543 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6545 yes | yes | yes | yes
6546 Arguments : none
6547
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006548 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006549 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6550 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6551 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6552 - IP (socket, server)
6553 - cookie (backend, server)
6554
6555 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6556 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006557 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006558
6559 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6560
6561
6562stats show-node [ <name> ]
6563 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006565 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006566 Arguments:
6567 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6568 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6569
6570 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6571 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006572 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006573
6574 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6575 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6576 unobvious parameters.
6577
6578 Example:
6579 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6580 backend private_monitoring
6581 stats enable
6582 stats show-node Europe-1
6583 stats uri /admin?stats
6584 stats refresh 5s
6585
6586 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6587 section.
6588
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006589
6590stats uri <prefix>
6591 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006593 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006594 Arguments :
6595 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6596 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6597 query string.
6598
6599 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6600 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6601 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6602 possible to reach it in the application.
6603
6604 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006605 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006606 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6607 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6608 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6609 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6610
6611 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6612 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6613 an address or a port to statistics only.
6614
6615 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6616 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6617 unobvious parameters.
6618
6619 Example :
6620 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6621 backend public_www
6622 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6623 stats enable
6624 stats hide-version
6625 stats scope .
6626 stats uri /admin?stats
6627 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6628 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6629 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6630
6631 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6632 backend private_monitoring
6633 stats enable
6634 stats uri /admin?stats
6635 stats refresh 5s
6636
6637 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6638
6639
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006640stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6641 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006643 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006644
6645 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006646 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006647 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6648 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6649 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6650
6651 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6652 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6653 the "stick-table" statement.
6654
6655 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6656 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6657 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6658 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6659 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6660
6661 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6662 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6663 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6664 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6665 transformation rules.
6666
6667 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6668 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6669 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6670 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6671 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6672 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6673 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6674
6675 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6676 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6677 ACL based conditions.
6678
6679 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6680 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6681 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6682 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6683
6684 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6685 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6686 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6687 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6688
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006689 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6690 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6691 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6692
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006693 Example :
6694 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6695 # last 30 minutes
6696 backend pop
6697 mode tcp
6698 balance roundrobin
6699 stick store-request src
6700 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6701 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6702 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6703
6704 backend smtp
6705 mode tcp
6706 balance roundrobin
6707 stick match src table pop
6708 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6709 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6710
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006711 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006712 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006713
6714
6715stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6716 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6718 no | no | yes | yes
6719
6720 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6721 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6722 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6723 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6724
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006725 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6726 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6727 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6728
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006729 Examples :
6730 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006731 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006732
6733 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6734 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6735 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6736
6737
6738 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6739 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6740 backend http
6741 mode http
6742 balance roundrobin
6743 stick on src table https
6744 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6745 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6746 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6747
6748 backend https
6749 mode tcp
6750 balance roundrobin
6751 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6752 stick on src
6753 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6754 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6755
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006756 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006757
6758
6759stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6760 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6762 no | no | yes | yes
6763
6764 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006765 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006766 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6767 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6768 server is selected.
6769
6770 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6771 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6772 the "stick-table" statement.
6773
6774 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6775 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6776 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6777 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6778 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6779 address.
6780
6781 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6782 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6783 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6784 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6785 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6786 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6787 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6788 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6789 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6790 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6791
6792 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6793 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6794 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6795 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6796 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6797 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6798 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6799
6800 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6801 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6802 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6803 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6804
6805 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6806 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6807 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6808 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6809 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6810 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006811 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6812 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6813 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6814 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6815 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6816 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006817
6818 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6819 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6820 the request.
6821
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006822 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6823 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6824 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6825
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006826 Example :
6827 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6828 # last 30 minutes
6829 backend pop
6830 mode tcp
6831 balance roundrobin
6832 stick store-request src
6833 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6834 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6835 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6836
6837 backend smtp
6838 mode tcp
6839 balance roundrobin
6840 stick match src table pop
6841 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6842 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6843
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006844 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006845 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006846
6847
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006848stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006849 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6850 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006851 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006853 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006854
6855 Arguments :
6856 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6857 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6858 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6859 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6860
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006861 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6862 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6863 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6864 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6865
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006866 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6867 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6868 instance.
6869
6870 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6871 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6872 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6873 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6874 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6875 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006876 to 32 characters.
6877
6878 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6879 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6880 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006881 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006882 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6883 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006884
6885 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006886 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6887 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006888 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6889 increase.
6890
6891 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006892 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6893 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6894 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006895
6896 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6897 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6898 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6899 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6900 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6901 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6902 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6903 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6904 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6905 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6906 parameter (see below).
6907
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006908 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6909 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6910 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6911 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6912 soft restart.
6913
Willy Tarreauc85ad792015-05-01 19:21:02 +02006914 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
6915 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006916
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006917 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6918 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6919 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6920 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6921 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006922 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006923 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6924 if not expiration delay is specified.
6925
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006926 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6927 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6928 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6929 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006930 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6931 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6932 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6933 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6934 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6935 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6936 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6937 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6938 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6939 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6940 types and their arguments.
6941
6942 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6943 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6944 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6945 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6946
6947 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6948 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6949 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6950 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6951
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006952 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6953 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6954 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6955 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6956 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6957 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6958
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006959 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6960 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6961 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6962 they were received.
6963
6964 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6965 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6966 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6967 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6968 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6969
6970 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6971 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6972 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6973 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6974 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6975
6976 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6977 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6978 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6979
6980 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6981 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6982 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6983 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6984 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6985
6986 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6987 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6988 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6989 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6990 the client side.
6991
6992 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6993 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6994 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6995 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6996 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6997 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6998 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6999
7000 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7001 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7002 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7003 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7004 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7005 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7006 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7007
7008 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7009 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7010 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7011 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7012 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7013 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7014
7015 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7016 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7017 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7018 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7019
7020 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7021 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7022 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7023 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7024 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7025 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7026 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7027 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7028 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7029 recommended for better fairness.
7030
7031 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7032 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7033 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7034 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7035
7036 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7037 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7038 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7039 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7040 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7041 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7042 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7043 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7044 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7045 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007046
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007047 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7048 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007049 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7050 reference it.
7051
7052 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7053 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7054 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7055 as an exclusive stickiness.
7056
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007057 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7058 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7059 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7060 something that can be ignored.
7061
7062 Example:
7063 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7064 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7065 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7066 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7067
7068 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007069 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007070
7071
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007072stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7073 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7075 no | no | yes | yes
7076
7077 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007078 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007079 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7080 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7081 server is selected.
7082
7083 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7084 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7085 the "stick-table" statement.
7086
7087 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7088 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7089 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7090 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7091
7092 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7093 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7094 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7095 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7096 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7097 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007098 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007099 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7100 rules.
7101
7102 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7103 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7104 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7105 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7106 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7107 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7108 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7109
7110 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7111 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7112 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7113 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7114
7115 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7116 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7117 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7118 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7119 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7120 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007121 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7122 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7123 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7124 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7125 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7126 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7127 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7128 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7129 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007130
7131 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7132
7133 Example :
7134 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7135 backend https
7136 mode tcp
7137 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007138 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007139 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007140
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007141 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7142 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7143
7144 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7145 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7146 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7147
7148 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7149 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007150
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007151 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7152 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7153 # at offset 44.
7154
7155 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7156 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7157
7158 # Learn on response if server hello.
7159 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007160
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007161 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7162 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7163
7164 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7165 extraction.
7166
7167
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007168tcp-check connect [params*]
7169 Opens a new connection
7170 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7171 no | no | yes | yes
7172
7173 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7174 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7175 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7176
7177 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7178 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7179 of the sequence.
7180
7181 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7182 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7183 do.
7184
7185 Parameters :
7186 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7187 use the TCP connection.
7188
7189 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7190 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7191 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7192
7193 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7194
7195 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7196
7197 Examples:
7198 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7199 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7200 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7201 option tcp-check
7202 tcp-check connect
7203 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7204 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7205 tcp-check send \r\n
7206 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7207 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7208 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7209 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7210 tcp-check send \r\n
7211 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7212 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7213
7214 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7215 option tcp-check
7216 tcp-check connect port 110
7217 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7218 tcp-check connect port 143
7219 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7220 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7221
7222 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7223
7224
7225tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7226 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7227 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7228 no | no | yes | yes
7229
7230 Arguments :
7231 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7232 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7233 binary.
7234 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7235 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7236 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7237
7238 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7239 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7240 with the usual backslash ('\').
7241 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7242 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7243 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7244 used upper or lower case.
7245
7246
7247 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7248
7249 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7250 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7251 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7252 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7253 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7254 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7255 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7256 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7257
7258 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7259 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7260 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7261 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7262 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7263 expression.
7264
7265 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7266 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7267 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7268 this exact hexadecimal string.
7269 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7270
7271 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7272 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7273 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7274 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7275 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7276 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7277 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7278 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7279 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7280 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7281 the null character.
7282
7283 Examples :
7284 # perform a POP check
7285 option tcp-check
7286 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7287
7288 # perform an IMAP check
7289 option tcp-check
7290 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7291
7292 # look for the redis master server
7293 option tcp-check
7294 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7295 tcp-check expect +PONG
7296 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7297 tcp-check expect string role:master
7298 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7299 tcp-check expect string +OK
7300
7301
7302 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7303 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7304
7305
7306tcp-check send <data>
7307 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7308 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7309 no | no | yes | yes
7310
7311 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7312 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7313
7314 Examples :
7315 # look for the redis master server
7316 option tcp-check
7317 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7318 tcp-check expect string role:master
7319
7320 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7321 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7322
7323
7324tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7325 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7326 tcp health check
7327 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7328 no | no | yes | yes
7329
7330 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7331 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7332 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7333 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7334 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7335 hexadecimal string.
7336 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7337
7338 Examples :
7339 # redis check in binary
7340 option tcp-check
7341 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7342 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7343
7344
7345 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7346 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7347
7348
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007349tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7350 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7352 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007353 Arguments :
7354 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007355 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7356 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007357
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007358 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007359
7360 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7361 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007362 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7363 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7364 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7365 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7366 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7367 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007368
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007369 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7370 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7371 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7372 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007373
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007374 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007375 - accept :
7376 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7377 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7378 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007379
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007380 - reject :
7381 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7382 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7383 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7384 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7385 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7386 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7387 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7388 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7389 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7390 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7391 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7392 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007393
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007394 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7395 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7396 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7397 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7398 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7399 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7400 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7401 hosts.
7402
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007403 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7404 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7405 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7406 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7407 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7408 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7409 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7410 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7411 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7412 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7413 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7414
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007415 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007416 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7417 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7418 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007419 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7420 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007421 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007422 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7423 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7424 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7425 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7426 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007427
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007428 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007429 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007430 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007431 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7432 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7433 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7434 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007435
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007436 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7437 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7438 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7439 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007440
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007441 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7442 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7443 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7444 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7445 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007446 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7447 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7448 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7449 layer7 information is extracted.
7450
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007451 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7452 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7453 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7454 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7455 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007456
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007457 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7458 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7459 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007460
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007461 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7462 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7463 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007464
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007465 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007466 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007467 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007468
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007469 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7470 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7471 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007472
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007473 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007474 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7475 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007476
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007477 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7478
7479 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7480
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007481 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7482
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007483 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007484
7485
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007486tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7487 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007489 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007490 Arguments :
7491 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007492 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007493 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7494 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007495
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007496 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007497
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007498 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7499 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7500 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7501 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7502 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007503
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007504 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7505 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7506 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7507 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007508 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7509 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7510 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7511 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7512 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7513 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007514 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007515 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007516
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007517 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7518 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7519 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7520 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007521
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007522 Four types of actions are supported :
7523 - accept : the request is accepted
7524 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7525 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007526 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007527
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007528 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7529 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007530
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007531 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7532 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7533 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7534 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7535 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7536 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007538 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007539 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7540 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007541
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007542 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007543 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7544 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7545 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7546 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007547 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7548 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7549 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007550
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007551 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007552 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7553 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7554 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007555
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007556 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007557 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7558 # and reject everything else.
7559 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7560 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007561 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007562 tcp-request content reject
7563
7564 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007565 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7566 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7567 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007568 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007569
7570 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7571 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7572 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007573 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007574 tcp-request content reject
7575
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007576 Example:
7577 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7578 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007579 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007580
7581 Example:
7582 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7583 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007584 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007585
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007586 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7587 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7588
7589 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007590 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007591 # protecting all our sites
7592 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007593 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7594 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007595 ...
7596 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7597
7598 backend http_dynamic
7599 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007600 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007601 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007602 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7603 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7604 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007605 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007607 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007608
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007609 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007610
7611
7612tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7613 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007615 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007616 Arguments :
7617 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7618 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7619 as explained at the top of this document.
7620
7621 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7622 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7623 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7624 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7625 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7626
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007627 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7628 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7629 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7630 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7631
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007632 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7633 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007634 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007635 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007636 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7637 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7638 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7639 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007640
7641 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7642 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7643 it pass through unaffected.
7644
7645 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7646 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7647 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007648 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007649 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7650 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007651 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7652 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7653 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007654
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007655 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007656 "timeout client".
7657
7658
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007659tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7660 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7662 no | no | yes | yes
7663 Arguments :
7664 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007665 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007666
7667 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7668
7669 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7670 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7671 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007672 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7673 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007674
7675 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7676
7677 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7678 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7679 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7680 inserted.
7681
7682 Two types of actions are supported :
7683 - accept :
7684 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7685 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7686 the rules evaluation.
7687
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007688 - close :
7689 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7690 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7691 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7692 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7693 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7694 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007695 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007696 protocols.
7697
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007698 - reject :
7699 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7700 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007701 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007702
7703 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7704 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7705 for changing the default action to a reject.
7706
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007707 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7708 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7709 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7710 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007711 period.
7712
7713 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7714
7715 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7716
7717
7718tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7719 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7721 no | no | yes | yes
7722 Arguments :
7723 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7724 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7725 as explained at the top of this document.
7726
7727 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7728
7729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007730timeout check <timeout>
7731 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7732 established.
7733
7734 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7735 yes | no | yes | yes
7736 Arguments:
7737 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7738 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7739 as explained at the top of this document.
7740
7741 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7742 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7743 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7744 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007745 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7746 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7747 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007748
7749 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7750 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7751
7752 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7753 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007754 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007755
7756 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7757 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7758 forget about it.
7759
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007760 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7761 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007762
7763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007764timeout client <timeout>
7765timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7766 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7768 yes | yes | yes | no
7769 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007770 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007771 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7772 as explained at the top of this document.
7773
7774 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7775 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7776 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7777 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7778 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7779 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7780 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7781 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007782 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007783 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007784 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7785 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007786 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7787 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007788
7789 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7790 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7791 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7792 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7793 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7794 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7795
7796 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7797 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7798 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7799
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007800 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007801
7802
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007803timeout client-fin <timeout>
7804 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7806 yes | yes | yes | no
7807 Arguments :
7808 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7809 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7810 as explained at the top of this document.
7811
7812 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7813 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7814 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7815 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7816 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7817 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7818 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7819 down in one direction.
7820
7821 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7822 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7823 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7824
7825 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7826
7827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007828timeout connect <timeout>
7829timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7830 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7832 yes | no | yes | yes
7833 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007834 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007835 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7836 as explained at the top of this document.
7837
7838 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007839 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007840 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007841 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007842 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7843 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007844
7845 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7846 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7847 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7848 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7849 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7850 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7851
7852 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7853 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7854 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7855
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007856 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7857 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007858
7859
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007860timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7861 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7863 yes | yes | yes | yes
7864 Arguments :
7865 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7866 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7867 as explained at the top of this document.
7868
7869 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7870 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7871 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7872 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7873 once the request has started to present itself.
7874
7875 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7876 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7877 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7878 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7879 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7880
7881 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7882 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7883 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7884 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7885
7886 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7887 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7888 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7889 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7890 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007891 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007892
7893 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7894 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7895 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7896 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7897
7898 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7899
7900
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007901timeout http-request <timeout>
7902 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007904 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007905 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007906 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007907 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7908 as explained at the top of this document.
7909
7910 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7911 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7912 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7913 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7914 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7915 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7916 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007917 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7918 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7919 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7920 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7921 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007922 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
7923 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007924
7925 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7926 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007927 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7928 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007929
7930 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7931 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7932 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7933 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7934 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7935
7936 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007937 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7938 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7939 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007940
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007941 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
7942 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007943
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007944
7945timeout queue <timeout>
7946 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7948 yes | no | yes | yes
7949 Arguments :
7950 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7951 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7952 as explained at the top of this document.
7953
7954 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7955 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7956 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7957 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7958 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7959
7960 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7961 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7962 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7963 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7964
7965 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7966
7967
7968timeout server <timeout>
7969timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7970 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7972 yes | no | yes | yes
7973 Arguments :
7974 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7975 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7976 as explained at the top of this document.
7977
7978 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7979 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7980 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7981 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7982 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7983 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7984 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7985
7986 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7987 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7988 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7989 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7990 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007991 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007992 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007993 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7994 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7995 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7996 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007997
7998 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7999 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8000 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8001 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8002 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8003 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8004
8005 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8006 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8007 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8008
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008009 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008010
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008011
8012timeout server-fin <timeout>
8013 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8015 yes | no | yes | yes
8016 Arguments :
8017 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8018 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8019 as explained at the top of this document.
8020
8021 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8022 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8023 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8024 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8025 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8026 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8027 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8028 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8029 situations, it should not be needed.
8030
8031 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8032 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8033 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8034
8035 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8036
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008037
8038timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008039 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8041 yes | yes | yes | yes
8042 Arguments :
8043 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8044 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8045 as explained at the top of this document.
8046
8047 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8048 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8049 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8050
8051 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8052 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8053 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8054 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008055 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008056
8057 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8058
8059
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008060timeout tunnel <timeout>
8061 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8063 yes | no | yes | yes
8064 Arguments :
8065 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8066 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8067 as explained at the top of this document.
8068
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008069 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008070 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8071 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8072 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8073 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8074 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8075 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8076 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8077 specified.
8078
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008079 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8080 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8081 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8082 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8083 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8084 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8085 state.
8086
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008087 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8088 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8089 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8090 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8091 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8092
8093 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8094 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8095 forget about it.
8096
8097 Example :
8098 defaults http
8099 option http-server-close
8100 timeout connect 5s
8101 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008102 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008103 timeout server 30s
8104 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8105
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008106 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008107
8108
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008109transparent (deprecated)
8110 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008112 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008113 Arguments : none
8114
8115 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8116 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8117 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8118 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8119 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8120 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8121 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8122 appropriate server.
8123
8124 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8125
8126 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8127 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8128
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008129 See also: "option transparent"
8130
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008131unique-id-format <string>
8132 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8134 yes | yes | yes | no
8135 Arguments :
8136 <string> is a log-format string.
8137
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008138 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8139 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8140 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8141 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008142
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008143 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8144 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8145 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8146 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8147 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8148 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8149 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8150 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008151
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008152 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8153 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008154
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008155 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008156
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008157 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008158
8159 will generate:
8160
8161 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8162
8163 See also: "unique-id-header"
8164
8165unique-id-header <name>
8166 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8168 yes | yes | yes | no
8169 Arguments :
8170 <name> is the name of the header.
8171
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008172 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8173 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008174
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008175 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008176
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008177 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008178 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8179
8180 will generate:
8181
8182 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8183
8184 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008185
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008186use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008187 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8189 no | yes | yes | no
8190 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008191 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8192 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008193
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008194 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8195 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008196
8197 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8198 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8199 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008200 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8201 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8202 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8203 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008204
8205 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8206 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8207 assign the backend.
8208
8209 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8210 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8211 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8212 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8213 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8214 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8215
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008216 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008217 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008218 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8219 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8220 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8221
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008222 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8223 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8224 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8225 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8226 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8227 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8228 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8229 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8230 cannot be forced from the request.
8231
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008232 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008233 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8234 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8235
8236 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8237 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008238
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008239
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008240use-server <server> if <condition>
8241use-server <server> unless <condition>
8242 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8244 no | no | yes | yes
8245 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008246 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008247
8248 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8249
8250 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8251 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8252 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8253
8254 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8255 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8256 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8257 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8258 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8259 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8260 matches will assign the server.
8261
8262 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8263 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8264 with the next rules until one matches.
8265
8266 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8267 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8268 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8269 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8270
8271 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8272 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8273 stripped.
8274
8275 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8276 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8277 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8278 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8279
8280 Example :
8281 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8282 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8283 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8284 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8285 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8286 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8287 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8288 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8289 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8290
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008291 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008292
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008293
82945. Bind and Server options
8295--------------------------
8296
8297The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8298depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8299settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8300written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8301described in this section.
8302
8303
83045.1. Bind options
8305-----------------
8306
8307The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8308as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8309no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8310parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8311while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8312provided immediately after the setting name.
8313
8314The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8315
8316accept-proxy
8317 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008318 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8319 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008320 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8321 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8322 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8323 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8324 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8325 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8326 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008327 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8328 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008329
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008330alpn <protocols>
8331 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8332 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8333 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8334 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8335 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8336 initial NPN extension.
8337
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008338backlog <backlog>
8339 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8340 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8341
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008342ecdhe <named curve>
8343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008344 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8345 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008346
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008347ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8349 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8350 client's certificate.
8351
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008352ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8353 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8354 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8355 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8356 error is ignored.
8357
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008358ciphers <ciphers>
8359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8360 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008361 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008362 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8363 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8364
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008365crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8367 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8368 to verify client's certificate.
8369
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008370crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8372 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8373 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8374 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8375 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8376 file.
8377
8378 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8379 are loaded.
8380
8381 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008382 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
8383 '.issuer' or '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified
8384 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8385 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
8386 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects.
8387 Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the
8388 first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008389 www.sub.example.org).
8390
8391 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8392 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8393 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8394 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008395 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8396 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008397
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008398 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008399
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008400 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8401 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008402 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008403 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8404 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8405 clients).
8406
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008407 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8408 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8409 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8410 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8411 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8412 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8413 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8414 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8415 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8416 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8417 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8418 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8419 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8420
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008421crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008422 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8423 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008424 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008425 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008426
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008427crt-list <file>
8428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008429 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8430 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008431
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008432 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008433
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008434 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8435 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8436 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8437 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8438 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8439 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8440 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8441 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008442
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008443defer-accept
8444 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8445 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8446 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8447 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8448 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8449 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8450 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8451 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8452 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8453 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8454 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8455
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008456force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008457 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008458 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008459 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8460 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008461
8462force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008463 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008464 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8465 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008466
8467force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008468 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008469 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8470 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008471
8472force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008473 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008474 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8475 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008476
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008477gid <gid>
8478 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8479 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8480 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8481 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8482 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8483
8484group <group>
8485 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8486 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8487 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8488 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8489 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8490
8491id <id>
8492 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8493 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8494 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8495 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8496
8497interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008498 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8499 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8500 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8501 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8502 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8503 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8504 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008505
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008506level <level>
8507 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8508 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8509 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8510 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8511 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8512 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8513 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8514 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8515 counters).
8516 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8517 all counters).
8518
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008519maxconn <maxconn>
8520 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8521 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8522 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8523 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8524 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8525 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8526 eat all memory.
8527
8528mode <mode>
8529 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8530 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8531 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8532 UNIX sockets.
8533
8534mss <maxseg>
8535 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8536 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8537 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8538 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8539 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8540 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8541 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8542 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8543 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8544 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8545 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8546
8547name <name>
8548 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8549 page.
8550
8551nice <nice>
8552 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8553 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8554 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8555 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8556 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8557 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8558 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8559 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8560 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8561 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8562 one for an RDP socket.
8563
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008564no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008565 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008566 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008567 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008568 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8569 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008570 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008571
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008572no-tls-tickets
8573 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8574 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8575 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008576 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8577 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008578
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008579no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008581 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008582 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008583 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8584 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8585 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008586
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008587no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008588 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008589 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008590 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008591 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8592 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8593 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008594
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008595no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008597 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008598 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008599 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8600 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8601 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008602
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008603npn <protocols>
8604 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8605 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8606 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8607 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008608 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8609 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008610
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008611process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8612 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8613 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8614 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8615 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8616 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8617 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8618 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008619 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8620 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8621 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8622 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8623 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8624 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8625 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008626
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008627ssl
8628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008629 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008630 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8631 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8632 to deciphered contents.
8633
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008634strict-sni
8635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8636 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8637 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8638 See the "crt" option for more information.
8639
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008640tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008641 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008642 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8643 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8644 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8645 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8646 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8647 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8648 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008649 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8650 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8651 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008652
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008653transparent
8654 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8655 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8656 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8657 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8658 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8659 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8660 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8661 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8662 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8663 so check for support with your vendor.
8664
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008665v4v6
8666 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8667 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8668 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8669 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008670 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008671
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008672v6only
8673 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8674 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8675 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008676 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8677 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008678
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008679uid <uid>
8680 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8681 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8682 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8683 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8684 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8685
8686user <user>
8687 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8688 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8689 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8690 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8691 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8692
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008693verify [none|optional|required]
8694 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8695 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8696 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8697 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8698 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008699 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8700 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8701 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8702 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008703
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020087045.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008705------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008707The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8708which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8709arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8710settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8711after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8712Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8713address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008715 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008716 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008718The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008719
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008720addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008721 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8722 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8723 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8724 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8725 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008727 Supported in default-server: No
8728
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008729agent-check
8730 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008731 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8732 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8733 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8734 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008735
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008736 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008737 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreau47067ca2014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008738 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8739 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8740 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008741
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008742 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8743 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008744
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008745 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8746 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8747 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008748
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008749 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8750 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8751 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008752
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008753 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8754 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8755 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8756 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8757 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8758 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8759 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008760
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008761 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8762 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008763
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008764 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8765 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8766 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8767 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8768 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8769 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8770 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8771 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8772 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008773
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008774 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8775 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008776 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8777 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8778 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8779 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008780
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008781 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8782 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008783
8784 Supported in default-server: No
8785
8786agent-inter <delay>
8787 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8788 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8789
8790 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8791 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8792 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8793 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8794 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8795 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8796 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8797 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8798 of backends use the same servers.
8799
8800 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8801
8802 Supported in default-server: Yes
8803
8804agent-port <port>
8805 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8806
8807 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8808
8809 Supported in default-server: Yes
8810
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008811backup
8812 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8813 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8814 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8815 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8816 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8817 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008819 Supported in default-server: No
8820
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008821ca-file <cafile>
8822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8823 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8824 server's certificate.
8825
8826 Supported in default-server: No
8827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008828check
8829 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008830 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8831 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8832 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8833 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8834 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8835 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8836 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008837 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8838 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8839 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008841 Supported in default-server: No
8842
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008843check-send-proxy
8844 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8845 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8846 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8847 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8848 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8849 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8850 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8851
8852 Supported in default-server: No
8853
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008854check-ssl
8855 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8856 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8857 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8858 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008859 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008860 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8861 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8862 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8863 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8864
8865 Supported in default-server: No
8866
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008867ciphers <ciphers>
8868 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008869 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008870 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8871 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8872 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8873 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8874 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8875 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8876
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008877 Supported in default-server: No
8878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008879cookie <value>
8880 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8881 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8882 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8883 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8884 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8885 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8886 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008888 Supported in default-server: No
8889
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008890crl-file <crlfile>
8891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8892 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8893 to verify server's certificate.
8894
8895 Supported in default-server: No
8896
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008897crt <cert>
8898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8899 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8900 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8901 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8902 certificate request.
8903
8904 Supported in default-server: No
8905
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008906disabled
8907 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8908 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8909 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8910 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8911 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8912
8913 Supported in default-server: No
8914
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008915error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008916 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8917 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8918 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008920 Supported in default-server: Yes
8921
8922 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008924fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008925 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8926 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8927 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8928
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008929 Supported in default-server: Yes
8930
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008931force-sslv3
8932 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8933 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008934 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8935 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008936
8937 Supported in default-server: No
8938
8939force-tlsv10
8940 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008941 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8942 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008943
8944 Supported in default-server: No
8945
8946force-tlsv11
8947 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008948 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8949 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008950
8951 Supported in default-server: No
8952
8953force-tlsv12
8954 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008955 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8956 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008957
8958 Supported in default-server: No
8959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008960id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008961 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8962 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8963 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008965 Supported in default-server: No
8966
8967inter <delay>
8968fastinter <delay>
8969downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008970 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8971 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8972 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8973 between checks depending on the server state :
8974
8975 Server state | Interval used
8976 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8977 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8978 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8979 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8980 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8981 or yet unchecked. |
8982 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8983 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8984 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008985
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008986 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8987 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8988 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8989 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008990 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8991 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8992 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8993 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8994 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008996 Supported in default-server: Yes
8997
8998maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008999 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9000 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9001 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9002 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9003 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9004 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9005 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9006 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9007
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009008 Supported in default-server: Yes
9009
9010maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009011 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9012 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9013 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9014 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9015 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9016 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9017 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009019 Supported in default-server: Yes
9020
9021minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009022 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9023 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9024 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9025 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9026 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9027 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009028 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009029 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009030
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009031 Supported in default-server: Yes
9032
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009033no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009034 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9035 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009036 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009037
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009038 Supported in default-server: No
9039
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009040no-tls-tickets
9041 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9042 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9043 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009044 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9045 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009046
9047 Supported in default-server: No
9048
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009049no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009050 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009051 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9052 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009053 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9054 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9055 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009056
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009057 Supported in default-server: No
9058
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009059no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009060 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009061 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9062 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009063 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9064 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9065 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009066
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009067 Supported in default-server: No
9068
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009069no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009070 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009071 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9072 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009073 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9074 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9075 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009076
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009077 Supported in default-server: No
9078
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009079non-stick
9080 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9081 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9082 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9083
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009084 Supported in default-server: No
9085
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009086observe <mode>
9087 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9088 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9089 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9090 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9091 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9092 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009093 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009095 Supported in default-server: No
9096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009097 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009099on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009100 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9101 Currently, four modes are available:
9102 - fastinter: force fastinter
9103 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9104 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9105 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9106 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009108 Supported in default-server: Yes
9109
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009110 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9111
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009112on-marked-down <action>
9113 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9114 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009115 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9116 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9117 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9118 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9119 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9120 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9121 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9122 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009123
9124 Actions are disabled by default
9125
9126 Supported in default-server: Yes
9127
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009128on-marked-up <action>
9129 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9130 Currently one action is available:
9131 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9132 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9133 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9134 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9135 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9136 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9137 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9138 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9139
9140 Actions are disabled by default
9141
9142 Supported in default-server: Yes
9143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009144port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009145 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9146 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9147 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9148 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9149 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9150 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009152 Supported in default-server: Yes
9153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009154redir <prefix>
9155 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9156 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9157 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9158 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9159 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9160 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9161 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9162 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009163 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009164 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9165 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9166 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9167 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9168 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9169
9170 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009172 Supported in default-server: No
9173
9174rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009175 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9176 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9177 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009179 Supported in default-server: Yes
9180
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009181send-proxy
9182 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9183 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9184 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9185 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9186 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9187 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9188 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9189 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9190 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009191 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9192 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9193 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9194 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9195 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009196
9197 Supported in default-server: No
9198
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009199send-proxy-v2
9200 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9201 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9202 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9203 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9204 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9205 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9206 option of the "bind" keyword.
9207
9208 Supported in default-server: No
9209
9210send-proxy-v2-ssl
9211 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9212 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9213 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9214 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9215 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9216 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9217 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9218 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9219
9220 Supported in default-server: No
9221
9222send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9223 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9224 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9225 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9226 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9227 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9228 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9229 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9230 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9231 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9232
9233 Supported in default-server: No
9234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009235slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009236 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9237 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9238 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9239 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9240 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9241 parameters :
9242
9243 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9244 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9245
9246 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9247 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9248 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9249 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9250
9251 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9252 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9253 seen as failed.
9254
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009255 Supported in default-server: Yes
9256
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009257source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009258source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009259source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009260 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9261 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9262 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9263 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9264
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009265 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9266 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9267 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9268 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9269 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9270 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9271 server.
9272
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009273 Supported in default-server: No
9274
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009275ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009276 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9277 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9278 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9279 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9280 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9281 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009282 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009283
9284 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009286track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009287 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9288 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9289 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9290 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009291 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009293 Supported in default-server: No
9294
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009295verify [none|required]
9296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009297 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9298 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9299 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9300 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009301 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9302 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9303 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009304
9305 Supported in default-server: No
9306
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009307verifyhost <hostname>
9308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9309 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9310 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9311 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9312 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9313 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9314
9315 Supported in default-server: No
9316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009317weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009318 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9319 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9320 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009321 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9322 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9323 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9324 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9325 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9326 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009328 Supported in default-server: Yes
9329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009330
93316. HTTP header manipulation
9332---------------------------
9333
9334In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9335response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9336request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9337which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009338against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009339
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009340If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9341to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9342but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9343HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9344stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9345because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9346a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9347still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009349This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9350in section 4.2 :
9351
9352 - reqadd <string>
9353 - reqallow <search>
9354 - reqiallow <search>
9355 - reqdel <search>
9356 - reqidel <search>
9357 - reqdeny <search>
9358 - reqideny <search>
9359 - reqpass <search>
9360 - reqipass <search>
9361 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9362 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9363 - reqtarpit <search>
9364 - reqitarpit <search>
9365 - rspadd <string>
9366 - rspdel <search>
9367 - rspidel <search>
9368 - rspdeny <search>
9369 - rspideny <search>
9370 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9371 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9372
9373With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9374is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9375parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9376prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9377Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9378
9379 \t for a tab
9380 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9381 \n for a new line (LF)
9382 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9383 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9384 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9385 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9386 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9387
9388The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9389portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9390above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9391regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93929 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9393is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9394
9395The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9396after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9397
9398Notes related to these keywords :
9399---------------------------------
9400 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9401 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9402 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9403
9404 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9405 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9406 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9407
9408 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9409 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9410 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9411 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9412 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9413
9414 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9415 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9416 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9417 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9418 useless headers before adding new ones.
9419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009420 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009421 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9422
9423 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9424 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9425 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9426
9427 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9428 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009429 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009430
9431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094327. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9433----------------------------------
9434
9435Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9436client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9437The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9438these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9439but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9440data called patterns.
9441
9442
94437.1. ACL basics
9444---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009445
9446The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9447content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9448from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9449simple :
9450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009451 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009452 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009453 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9454 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009456The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9457adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009458
9459In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009461 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009462
9463This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9464Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9465and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009466an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9467conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9468as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9469are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009470
9471ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9472'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9473which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9474
9475There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9476performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009478The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9479specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9480this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009481methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9482ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009483
9484Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9485 - boolean
9486 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9487 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9488 - string
9489 - data block
9490
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009491Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9492converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9493would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9494The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9495which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9496
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009497Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9498keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9499fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9500which are summarized in the table below :
9501
9502 +---------------------+-----------------+
9503 | Sample or converter | Default |
9504 | output type | matching method |
9505 +---------------------+-----------------+
9506 | boolean | bool |
9507 +---------------------+-----------------+
9508 | integer | int |
9509 +---------------------+-----------------+
9510 | ip | ip |
9511 +---------------------+-----------------+
9512 | string | str |
9513 +---------------------+-----------------+
9514 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9515 +---------------------+-----------------+
9516
9517Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9518matching method, see below.
9519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009520The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9521 - boolean
9522 - integer or integer range
9523 - IP address / network
9524 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9525 - regular expression
9526 - hex block
9527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009528The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9529
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009530 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9531 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009532 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009533 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009534 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009535 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009536 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009538The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9539read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9540if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9541lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9542will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9543beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9544a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9545lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9546exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9547
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009548The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9549parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9550ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9551a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9552check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9553
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009554The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9555socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9556file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009558Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9559loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9560
9561 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9562
9563In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9564the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9565case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9566as well.
9567
9568The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9569sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9570do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9571methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9572is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9573obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9574followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9575default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9576that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9577string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9578
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009579The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9580By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9581string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9582resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9583server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9584waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9585flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9586function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009588There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9589sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9590be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009591
9592 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9593 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009594 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9595 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9596 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9597 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009598
9599 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9600 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009601 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009602
9603 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009604 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009605
9606 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009607 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009608
9609 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9610 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9611
9612 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9613 binary or string samples.
9614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009615 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9616 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009618 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9619 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9620 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009622 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9623 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009625 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9626 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009628 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9629 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009631 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9632 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009633 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009635 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9636 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9637 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009638
9639For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9640request, it is possible to do :
9641
9642 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9643
9644In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9645buffer, one would use the following acl :
9646
9647 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9648
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009649On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9650possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9651
9652 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009654All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9655criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9656method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9657to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9658criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9659the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009661If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009662the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9663For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009665 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9666 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9667 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9668 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009669
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009670
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009671The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9672types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9673combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9674brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9675default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009677 +-------------------------------------------------+
9678 | Input sample type |
9679 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009680 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009681 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9682 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9683 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009684 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009685 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009686 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009687 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009688 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009689 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009690 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009691 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009692 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009693 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009694 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009695 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009696 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009697 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009698 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009699 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009700 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009701 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009702 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009703 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009704 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009705 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9706 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9707 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009708
9709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097107.1.1. Matching booleans
9711------------------------
9712
9713In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9714Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9715When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9716that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9717
9718Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9719return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9720"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9721
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097237.1.2. Matching integers
9724------------------------
9725
9726Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9727enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9728to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9729
9730Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9731matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9732lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009733
9734For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9735unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9736representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9737
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009738As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9739two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9740instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9741ranges and operators.
9742
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009743For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009744operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9745Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9746of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009747
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009748Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009749
9750 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9751 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9752 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9753 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9754 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009756For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009757
9758 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9759
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009760This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9761
9762 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097657.1.3. Matching strings
9766-----------------------
9767
9768String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9769different forms :
9770
9771 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9772 patterns ;
9773
9774 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9775 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9776
9777 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9778 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9779
9780 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9781 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9782
9783 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9784 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9785 matches.
9786
9787 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9788 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9789 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009790
9791String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9792exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9793characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9794string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9795to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009796before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009797
9798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097997.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9800---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009801
9802Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9803they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9804possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9805passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9806the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009807the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9808match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009809
9810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098117.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9812-------------------------------------
9813
9814It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9815not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9816a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9817to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9818digits may be used upper or lower case.
9819
9820Example :
9821 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9822 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9823
9824
98257.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9826---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009827
9828IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9829netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9830within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009831host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009832difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9833at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9834does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9835parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009836
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009837IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9838Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9839trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9840IPv6 patterns.
9841
9842HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9843following situations :
9844 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9845 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9846 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9847 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9848 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9849 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9850 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9851 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9852 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9853 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009855
98567.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9857----------------------------------
9858
9859Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9860combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9861
9862 - AND (implicit)
9863 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9864 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009866A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009868 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009870Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9871indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009873For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9874"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9875requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9876is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9877
9878 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9879 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9880 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9881 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9882
9883To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9884and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9885
9886 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9887 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9888 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9889 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9890
9891 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9892 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9893 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9894 use_backend www if host_www
9895
9896It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9897expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9898be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9899the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9900
9901 The following rule :
9902
9903 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9904 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9905
9906 Can also be written that way :
9907
9908 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9909
9910It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9911to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9912simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9913sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9914good use is the following :
9915
9916 With named ACLs :
9917
9918 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9919 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9920 monitor fail if site_dead
9921
9922 With anonymous ACLs :
9923
9924 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9925
9926See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9927
9928
99297.3. Fetching samples
9930---------------------
9931
9932Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9933against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9934sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9935ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9936of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9937available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9938
9939This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9940Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9941compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9942deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9943
9944The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9945matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9946method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9947indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9948
9949As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9950when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9951mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9952the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9953ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9954
9955Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9956multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9957when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9958incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9959are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9960is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9961all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9962
9963Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9964 - name
9965 - name(arg1)
9966 - name(arg1,arg2)
9967
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009968
99697.3.1. Converters
9970-----------------
9971
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009972Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9973of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9974is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9975was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9976has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9977unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9978
9979These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9980sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9981the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9982support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009984The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009985
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009986base64
9987 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9988 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9989 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9990
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009991hex
9992 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9993 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9994 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9995 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009996
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009997http_date([<offset>])
9998 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9999 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10000 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10001 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10002 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10003 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010004
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010005ipmask(<mask>)
10006 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10007 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10008 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10009 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10010
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010011language(<value>[,<default>])
10012 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10013 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10014 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10015 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10016 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10017 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10018 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10019 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10020 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10021 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10022 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10023 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010024
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010025 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010026
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010027 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10028 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010029
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010030 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10031 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10032 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10033 use_backend spanish if es
10034 use_backend french if fr
10035 use_backend english if en
10036 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010037
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010038lower
10039 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10040 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10041 type. The result is of type string.
10042
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010043map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10044map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10045map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10046 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10047 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10048 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10049 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10050 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10051 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10052 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10053 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010054
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010055 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10056 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10057 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010058
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010059 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10060 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010061
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010062 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10063 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10064 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10065 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010066 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10067 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010068 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10069 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10070 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10071 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10072 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10073 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10074 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10075 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10076 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10077 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10078 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10079 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10080 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10081 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010082
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010083 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10084 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10085 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10086 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10087 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010088
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010089 Example :
10090
10091 # this is a comment and is ignored
10092 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10093 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10094 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10095 | | | `---------- value
10096 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10097 | `---------------------------- key
10098 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10099
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010100upper
10101 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10102 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10103 type. The result is of type string.
10104
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010105
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200101067.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010107--------------------------------------------
10108
10109A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10110not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10111"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10112The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10113
10114always_false : boolean
10115 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10116 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10117
10118always_true : boolean
10119 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10120 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10121
10122avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010123 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010124 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10125 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10126 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10127 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10128 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10129 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10130 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10131 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10132 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10133 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10134 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10135 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10136 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010138be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010139 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10140 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10141 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10142 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10143 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010145be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10146 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10147 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10148 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10149 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10150 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10151 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010152
10153 Example :
10154 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10155 backend dynamic
10156 mode http
10157 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10158 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010160connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10161 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010162 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010163 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10164 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010165
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010166 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010167 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010168 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10169
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010170 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10171 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010172
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010173 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010174 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010175 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010176 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10177 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010178 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010179 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010180
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010181 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10182 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010183 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010184 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010185
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010186date([<offset>]) : integer
10187 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10188 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10189 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10190 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010191 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10192
10193 Example :
10194
10195 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10196 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010197
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010198env(<name>) : string
10199 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10200 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10201 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10202 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10203 certain way.
10204
10205 Examples :
10206 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10207 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10208
10209 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10210 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010212fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10213 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010214 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10215 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010216 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10217 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10218 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10219 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10220 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010222fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10223 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10224 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10225 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10226 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10227 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10228 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10229 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10230 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010231
10232 Example :
10233 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10234 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10235 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10236 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10237 frontend mail
10238 bind :25
10239 mode tcp
10240 maxconn 100
10241 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10242 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10243 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10244 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010245
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010246nbproc : integer
10247 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10248 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10249 and debugging purposes.
10250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010251nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10252 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10253 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10254 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010255 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10256 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10257 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010258
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010259proc : integer
10260 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10261 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10262 debugging purposes.
10263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010264queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010265 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10266 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10267 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010268 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10269 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10270 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10271 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10272 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10273
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010274rand([<range>]) : integer
10275 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10276 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10277 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10278 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10279 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010281srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10282 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10283 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10284 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10285 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10286 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10287 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10288 methods.
10289
10290srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10291 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10292 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10293 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10294 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10295 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10296 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10297 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10298
10299srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10300 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10301 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010302 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010303 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10304 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10305 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10306 overloading servers).
10307
10308 Example :
10309 # Redirect to a separate back
10310 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10311 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10312 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10313
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010314stopping : boolean
10315 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10316 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10317 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010319table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10320 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10321 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10322
10323table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10324 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10325 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10326 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10327
10328
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200103297.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010330----------------------------------
10331
10332The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10333closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10334methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10335sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10336TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010337the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10338counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10339"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010340argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10341the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10342this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010343
10344be_id : integer
10345 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10346 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10347
10348dst : ip
10349 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10350 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10351 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10352 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10353 RFC 4291.
10354
10355dst_conn : integer
10356 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10357 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10358 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10359 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10360 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10361 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10362 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10363 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010365dst_port : integer
10366 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10367 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10368 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10369 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10370 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10371 an HTTP header.
10372
10373fe_id : integer
10374 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10375 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10376 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010378sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010379sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10380sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10381sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010382 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10383 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10384 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10385
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010386sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010387sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10388sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10389sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010390 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10391 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10392 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10393
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010394sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010395sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10396sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10397sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010398 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10399 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010400 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10401 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10402 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010403
10404 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10405 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010406 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10407 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10408 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010409 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10410 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10411
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010412sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010413sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10414sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10415sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010416 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10417 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010419sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010420sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10421sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10422sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010423 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10424 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10425 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10426
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010427sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010428sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10429sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10430sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010431 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10432 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10433 See also src_conn_rate.
10434
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010435sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010436sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10437sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10438sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010439 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010440 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010441
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010442sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010443sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10444sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10445sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010446 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10447 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10448 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010449 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10450 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10451 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010452
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010453sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010454sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10455sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10456sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010457 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10458 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10459 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10460
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010461sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010462sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10463sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10464sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010465 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10466 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10467 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10468 src_http_err_rate.
10469
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010470sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010471sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10472sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10473sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010474 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10475 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10476 src_http_req_cnt.
10477
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010478sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010479sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10480sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10481sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010482 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10483 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10484 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10485 src_http_req_rate.
10486
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010487sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010488sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10489sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10490sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010491 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010492 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10493 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10494 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10495 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010496
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010497 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10498 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010499 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10500
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010501sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010502sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10503sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10504sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010505 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10506 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10507 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010508
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010509sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010510sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10511sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10512sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010513 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10514 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10515 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010516
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010517sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010518sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10519sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10520sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010521 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10522 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10523 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10524 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010525 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010526 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10527
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010528sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010529sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10530sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10531sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010532 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10533 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10534 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10535 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10536 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010537 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010538
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010539sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010540sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10541sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10542sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010543 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10544 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10545 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10546
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010547sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010548sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10549sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10550sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010551 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10552 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010553 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010554 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10555 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010556 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10557 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10558 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010560so_id : integer
10561 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10562 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10563 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010565src : ip
10566 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10567 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10568 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10569 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10570 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10571 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10572 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010573
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010574 Example:
10575 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10576 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010578src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10579 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10580 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10581 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010582 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010584src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10585 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10586 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010587 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010588 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010590src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10591 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10592 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10593 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10594 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10595 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10596 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010597
10598 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10599 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10600 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10601 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010602 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010603 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10604 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010606src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010607 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010608 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010609 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010610 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010612src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010613 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010614 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10615 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010616 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010618src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10619 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10620 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10621 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010622 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010624src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010625 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010626 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010627 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010628 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010630src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010631 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010632 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010633 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10634 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010635 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10636 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10637 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010639src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10640 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10641 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010642 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010643 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010644 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010646src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10647 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10648 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10649 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10650 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010651 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010653src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10654 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10655 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10656 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010657 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010659src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10660 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10661 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10662 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010663 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010664 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010666src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10667 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10668 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10669 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010670 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010671 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10672 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010673
10674 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010675 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010676 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010678src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010679 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10680 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10681 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10682 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10683 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010685src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010686 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10687 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10688 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10689 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10690 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010692src_port : integer
10693 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10694 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10695 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10696 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010698src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10699 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010700 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10701 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10702 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010703 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010705src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10706 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10707 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10708 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10709 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010710 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010712src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10713 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10714 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10715 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10716 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10717 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10718 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10719 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10720 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010721
10722 Example :
10723 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10724 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10725 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10726 listen ssh
10727 bind :22
10728 mode tcp
10729 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010730 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010731 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010732 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010734srv_id : integer
10735 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10736 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10737 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010738
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010739
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107407.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010741----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010743The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10744closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10745when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10746usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010747future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010748
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010749ssl_bc : boolean
10750 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10751 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10752 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10753
10754ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10755 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10756 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10757
10758ssl_bc_cipher : string
10759 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10760 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10761
10762ssl_bc_protocol : string
10763 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10764 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10765
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010766ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010767 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010768 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10769 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010770
10771ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10772 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10773 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10774 if session was reused or not.
10775
10776ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10777 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10778 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010780ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10781 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10782 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10783 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10784 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10785 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010787ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10788 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10789 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10790 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10791 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010792
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010793ssl_c_der : binary
10794 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
10795 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10796 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010798ssl_c_err : integer
10799 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10800 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10801 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10802 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10803 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010805ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10806 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10807 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10808 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10809 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10810 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10811 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10812 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10813 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010815ssl_c_key_alg : string
10816 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10817 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10818 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010820ssl_c_notafter : string
10821 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10822 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10823 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010825ssl_c_notbefore : string
10826 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10827 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10828 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010830ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10831 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10832 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10833 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10834 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10835 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10836 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10837 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10838 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010840ssl_c_serial : binary
10841 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10842 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10843 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010845ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10846 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10847 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10848 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau9fe4cb62014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010849 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10850 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10851
10852 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010854ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10855 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10856 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10857 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010859ssl_c_used : boolean
10860 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10861 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010863ssl_c_verify : integer
10864 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10865 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10866 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10867 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010869ssl_c_version : integer
10870 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10871 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010872
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010873ssl_f_der : binary
10874 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
10875 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10876 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010878ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10879 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10880 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10881 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10882 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010883 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010884 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10885 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10886 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010888ssl_f_key_alg : string
10889 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10890 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10891 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010893ssl_f_notafter : string
10894 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10895 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10896 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010898ssl_f_notbefore : string
10899 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10900 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10901 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010903ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10904 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10905 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10906 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10907 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10908 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10909 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10910 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10911 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010913ssl_f_serial : binary
10914 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10915 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10916 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010917
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010918ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10919 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10920 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10921 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010923ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10924 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10925 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10926 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010928ssl_f_version : integer
10929 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10930 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10931
10932ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010933 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10934 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10935 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010937 Example :
10938 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10939 listen http-https
10940 bind :80
10941 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10942 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10943
10944ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10945 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10946 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10947
10948ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010949 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010950 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10951 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10952 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10953 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10954 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10955 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10956 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10957 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010959ssl_fc_cipher : string
10960 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10961 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010963ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010964 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10965 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010966 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10967 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10968 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10969 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010971ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10972 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010973 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10974 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10975 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10976 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010978ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010979 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010980 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10981 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10982 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10983 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10984 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10985 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10986 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010988ssl_fc_protocol : string
10989 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10990 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010991
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010992ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010993 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010994 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10995 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010997ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10998 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10999 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11000 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11001 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011003ssl_fc_sni : string
11004 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11005 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11006 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11007 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11008 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11009
11010 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11011 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11012 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011013 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11014 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011016 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011017 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11018 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011020ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11021 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11022 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011023
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011024
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200110257.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011026------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011028Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11029sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11030only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11031For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11032be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11033can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11034sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11035for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11036content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011038payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11039 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11040 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11041 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011043payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11044 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11045 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11046 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011048req.len : integer
11049req_len : integer (deprecated)
11050 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11051 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11052 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11053 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11054 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11055 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11056 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11057 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011059req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11060 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011061 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11062 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11063 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11064 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011066 ACL alternatives :
11067 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011069req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11070 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11071 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11072 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11073 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011075 ACL alternatives :
11076 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011078 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011080req.proto_http : boolean
11081req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11082 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11083 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11084 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11085 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11086 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11087 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11088 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011090 Example:
11091 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11092 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11093 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011094 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011096req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11097rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11098 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11099 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11100 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11101 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11102 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11103 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11104 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011106 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11107 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11108 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11109 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11110 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11111 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011113 ACL derivatives :
11114 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011116 Example :
11117 listen tse-farm
11118 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11119 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11120 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11121 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11122 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11123 persist rdp-cookie
11124 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11125 # This is only useful makes sense if
11126 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11127 stick-table type string size 204800
11128 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11129 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11130 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011132 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11133 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011135req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11136rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11137 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11138 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11139 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11140 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011142 ACL derivatives :
11143 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011145req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11146req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11147 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11148 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11149 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11150 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11151 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11152 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11153 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011155req.ssl_sni : string
11156req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11157 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11158 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11159 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11160 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11161 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11162 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11163 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11164 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11165 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11166 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11167 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11168 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170 ACL derivatives :
11171 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011173 Examples :
11174 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11175 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11176 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11177 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11178 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011180res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11181rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11182 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11183 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11184 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11185 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11186 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11187 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11188 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011190req.ssl_ver : integer
11191req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11192 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11193 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11194 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11195 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11196 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11197 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11198 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11199 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11200 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011202 ACL derivatives :
11203 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011204
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011205res.len : integer
11206 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11207 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11208 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11209 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11210 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11211 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11212 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11213 content inspection.
11214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011215res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11216 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011217 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11218 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11219 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11220 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011222res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11223 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11224 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11225 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11226 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011228 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011230wait_end : boolean
11231 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11232 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11233 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11234 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11235 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11236 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11237 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11238 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011240 Examples :
11241 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11242 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11243 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011245 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11246 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11247 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11248 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11249 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11250 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11251 tcp-request content reject
11252
11253
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200112547.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011255--------------------------------------
11256
11257It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11258This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11259data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11260its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11261HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11262content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11263to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11264more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11265response are indexed.
11266
11267base : string
11268 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11269 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11270 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11271 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11272 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11273 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11274 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11275 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11276
11277 ACL derivatives :
11278 base : exact string match
11279 base_beg : prefix match
11280 base_dir : subdir match
11281 base_dom : domain match
11282 base_end : suffix match
11283 base_len : length match
11284 base_reg : regex match
11285 base_sub : substring match
11286
11287base32 : integer
11288 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11289 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11290 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11291 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11292
11293base32+src : binary
11294 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11295 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11296 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11297 per-URL counters.
11298
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011299capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11300 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11301 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11302 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11303
11304capture.req.method : string
11305 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11306 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11307 because it's allocated.
11308
11309capture.req.uri : string
11310 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11311 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11312 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11313 allocated.
11314
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011315capture.req.ver : string
11316 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11317 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11318 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11319
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011320capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11321 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11322 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11323 The first entry is an index of 0.
11324 See also: "capture response header"
11325
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011326capture.res.ver : string
11327 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11328 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11329 persistent flag.
11330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011331req.cook([<name>]) : string
11332cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11333 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11334 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11335 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11336 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11337 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11338 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11339 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11340 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11341
11342 ACL derivatives :
11343 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11344 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11345 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11346 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11347 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11348 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11349 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11350 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011352req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11353cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11354 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11355 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011357req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11358cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11359 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11360 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11361 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11362 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011364cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11365 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11366 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11367 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11368 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11369 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11370 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11371 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11372 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11373 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11374 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011376hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11377 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11378 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11379 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11380 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011381 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011383req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11384 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11385 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11386 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11387 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11388 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11389 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11390 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11391 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011393req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11394 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11395 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11396 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11397 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011399req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11400 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11401 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11402 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11403 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11404 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11405 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11406 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11407 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11408 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11409 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11410 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011412 ACL derivatives :
11413 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11414 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11415 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11416 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11417 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11418 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11419 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11420 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11421
11422req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11423hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11424 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11425 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11426 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11427 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11428 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11429 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11430 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11431 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11432 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11433
11434req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11435hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11436 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11437 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11438 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11439 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11440 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11441 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11442 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11443 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11444
11445req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11446hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11447 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11448 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11449 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11450 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11451 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11452 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11453 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11454
11455http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11456 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11457 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11458 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11459 basic auth is supported.
11460
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011461http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11462 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11463 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11464 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11465 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011466 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11467 basic auth is supported.
11468
11469 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011470 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11471 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11472 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11473 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011474
11475http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011476 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11477 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011478 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11479 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011481method : integer + string
11482 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11483 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11484 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11485 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11486 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11487 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11488 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011490 ACL derivatives :
11491 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493 Example :
11494 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11495 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11496 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011498path : string
11499 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11500 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11501 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11502 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11503 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11504 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11505 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507 ACL derivatives :
11508 path : exact string match
11509 path_beg : prefix match
11510 path_dir : subdir match
11511 path_dom : domain match
11512 path_end : suffix match
11513 path_len : length match
11514 path_reg : regex match
11515 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011517req.ver : string
11518req_ver : string (deprecated)
11519 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11520 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11521 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011523 ACL derivatives :
11524 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011526res.comp : boolean
11527 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11528 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11529 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011531res.comp_algo : string
11532 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11533 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11534 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011536res.cook([<name>]) : string
11537scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11538 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11539 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11540 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011542 ACL derivatives :
11543 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011545res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11546scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11547 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11548 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11549 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011551res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11552scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11553 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11554 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11555 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011557res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11558 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11559 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11560 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11561 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11562 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11563 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11564 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11565 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11566 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011568res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11569 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11570 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11571 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11572 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11573 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011575res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11576shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11577 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11578 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11579 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11580 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11581 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11582 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11583 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11584 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011586 ACL derivatives :
11587 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11588 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11589 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11590 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11591 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11592 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11593 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11594 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11595
11596res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11597shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11598 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11599 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11600 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11601 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11602 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011604res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11605shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11606 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11607 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11608 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11609 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11610 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11611 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011613res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11614shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11615 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11616 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11617 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11618 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11619 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11620 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011622res.ver : string
11623resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11624 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11625 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011627 ACL derivatives :
11628 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011630set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11631 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11632 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11633 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11634 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011636 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11637 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011639 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011641status : integer
11642 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11643 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11644 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011646url : string
11647 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11648 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11649 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11650 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11651 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11652 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11653 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011655 ACL derivatives :
11656 url : exact string match
11657 url_beg : prefix match
11658 url_dir : subdir match
11659 url_dom : domain match
11660 url_end : suffix match
11661 url_len : length match
11662 url_reg : regex match
11663 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011665url_ip : ip
11666 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11667 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11668 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11669 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11670 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11671 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11672 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011674url_port : integer
11675 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11676 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11677 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11678 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011680urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11681url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11682 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11683 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11684 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11685 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11686 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11687 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11688 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11689 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11690 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011692 ACL derivatives :
11693 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11694 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11695 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11696 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11697 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11698 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11699 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11700 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011701
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011703 Example :
11704 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11705 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11706 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11707 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011709urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11710 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11711 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11712 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011713
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117157.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011716---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011718Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11719every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011720order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011722ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11723---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011724FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011725HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011726HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11727HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011728HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11729HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11730HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11731HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11732LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011733METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11734METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11735METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11736METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11737METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11738METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011739RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011740REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011741TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011742WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11743---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011744
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117468. Logging
11747----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011748
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011749One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11750provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11751very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11752provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11753state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011754to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011755headers.
11756
11757In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11758about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11759send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11760
11761 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11762 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11763 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11764 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11765 at the termination.
11766
11767The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11768allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11769as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11770while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11771real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11772delay.
11773
11774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117758.1. Log levels
11776---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011777
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011778TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011779source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011780HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11781in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11782track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11783syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11784about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011785
11786
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117878.2. Log formats
11788----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011789
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011790HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011791and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11792slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11793options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011794
11795 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11796 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11797 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11798 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11799 extents.
11800
11801 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11802 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11803 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11804 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11805 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11806
11807 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11808 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11809 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11810 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11811 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11812
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011813 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11814 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11815 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11816 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11817
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011818 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11819
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011820Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11821specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11822field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11823servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11824always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11825identifier.
11826
11827Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11828 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11829 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11830 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11831 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11832
11833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118348.2.1. Default log format
11835-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011836
11837This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11838as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11839format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11840
11841 Example :
11842 listen www
11843 mode http
11844 log global
11845 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11846
11847 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11848 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11849 (www/HTTP)
11850
11851 Field Format Extract from the example above
11852 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11853 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11854 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11855 4 'to' to
11856 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11857 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11858
11859Detailed fields description :
11860 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11861 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11862 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11863 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11864 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11865 and processed the connection.
11866 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11867
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011868In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11869"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11870connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11871
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011872It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11873will eventually disappear.
11874
11875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118768.2.2. TCP log format
11877---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011878
11879The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11880is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11881information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11882counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11883emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11884environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11885the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11886sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011887specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11888not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11889fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11890marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011891
11892 Example :
11893 frontend fnt
11894 mode tcp
11895 option tcplog
11896 log global
11897 default_backend bck
11898
11899 backend bck
11900 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11901
11902 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11903 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11904 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11905
11906 Field Format Extract from the example above
11907 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11908 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11909 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11910 4 frontend_name fnt
11911 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11912 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11913 7 bytes_read* 212
11914 8 termination_state --
11915 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11916 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11917
11918Detailed fields description :
11919 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011920 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11921 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11922 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11923 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11924 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011925
11926 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011927 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11928 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11929 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011930
11931 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11932 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11933 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11934 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11935
11936 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11937 and processed the connection.
11938
11939 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11940 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11941 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11942 applications.
11943
11944 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11945 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11946 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11947 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11948 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11949
11950 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11951 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11952 See "Timers" below for more details.
11953
11954 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11955 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11956 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11957 "Timers" below for more details.
11958
11959 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011960 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011961 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11962 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11963 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11964 details.
11965
11966 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11967 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11968 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11969 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11970 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11971
11972 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11973 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11974 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11975 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11976 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11977 for more details.
11978
11979 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011980 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011981 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11982 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11983 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011984 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011985
11986 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11987 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11988 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11989 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11990 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11991 caused by a denial of service attack.
11992
11993 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11994 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11995 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11996 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11997 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11998 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11999 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12000 denial of service attack.
12001
12002 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12003 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12004 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12005 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12006 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12007 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12008 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12009 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12010 be processed than on other servers.
12011
12012 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12013 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12014 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12015 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12016 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12017 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12018 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12019 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12020 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12021 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12022 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12023 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12024 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12025
12026 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12027 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12028 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12029 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12030 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12031 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12032 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12033 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12034
12035 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12036 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12037 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12038 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12039 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12040 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12041 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12042 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12043 occurs.
12044
12045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120468.2.3. HTTP log format
12047----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012048
12049The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12050is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12051the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12052are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12053emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12054generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12055"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12056which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012057frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12058is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012059
12060Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12061slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12062with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12063
12064 Example :
12065 frontend http-in
12066 mode http
12067 option httplog
12068 log global
12069 default_backend bck
12070
12071 backend static
12072 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12073
12074 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12075 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12076 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012077 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012078
12079 Field Format Extract from the example above
12080 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12081 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12082 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12083 4 frontend_name http-in
12084 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12085 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12086 7 status_code 200
12087 8 bytes_read* 2750
12088 9 captured_request_cookie -
12089 10 captured_response_cookie -
12090 11 termination_state ----
12091 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12092 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12093 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12094 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12095 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012097
12098Detailed fields description :
12099 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012100 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12101 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12102 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12103 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12104 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012105
12106 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012107 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12108 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12109 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012110
12111 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12112 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12113 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12114 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12115 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12116
12117 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12118 and processed the connection.
12119
12120 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12121 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12122 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12123
12124 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12125 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12126 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12127 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12128 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12129 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12130
12131 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12132 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12133 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12134 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12135 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12136 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12137
12138 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12139 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12140 See "Timers" below for more details.
12141
12142 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12143 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12144 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12145 below for more details.
12146
12147 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12148 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12149 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12150 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12151 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12152 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12153 for more details.
12154
12155 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012156 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012157 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12158 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12159 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12160 details.
12161
12162 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12163 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12164 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12165
12166 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12167 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12168 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12169 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12170 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12171 overflowing.
12172
12173 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12174 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12175 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12176 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12177 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12178 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12179 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12180 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12181
12182 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12183 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12184 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12185 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12186 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12187 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12188 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12189 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12190
12191 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12192 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12193 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12194 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12195 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12196 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12197 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12198
12199 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012200 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012201 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12202 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12203 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012204 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012205 system.
12206
12207 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12208 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12209 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12210 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12211 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12212 caused by a denial of service attack.
12213
12214 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12215 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12216 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12217 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12218 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12219 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12220 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12221 denial of service attack.
12222
12223 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12224 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12225 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12226 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12227 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12228 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12229 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12230 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12231 processed than on other servers.
12232
12233 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12234 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12235 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12236 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12237 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12238 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12239 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12240 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12241 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12242 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12243 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12244 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12245 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12246
12247 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12248 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12249 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12250 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12251 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12252 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12253 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12254 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12255
12256 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12257 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12258 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12259 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12260 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12261 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12262 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12263 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12264 occurs.
12265
12266 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12267 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12268 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12269 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12270 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12271 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12272 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12273 cookies" below for more details.
12274
12275 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12276 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12277 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12278 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12279 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12280 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12281 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12282 and cookies" below for more details.
12283
12284 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12285 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12286 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12287 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12288 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12289 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12290 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12291 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12292
12293
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200122948.2.4. Custom log format
12295------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012296
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012297The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012298mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012299
12300HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12301Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12302separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12303prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12304
12305Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12306variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12307string formats ("Q").
12308
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012309If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012310as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012311less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12312the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12313
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012314Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012315In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012316in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012317
12318Flags are :
12319 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012320 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012321
12322 Example:
12323
12324 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12325 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12326
12327At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12328
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012329 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12330 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012331
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012332the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012333
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012334 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012335 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012336 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012337
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012338and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12339
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012340 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012341 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12342
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012343Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12344
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012345 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012346 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012347 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12348 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12349 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012350 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12351 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12352 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012353 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012354 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012355 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012356 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012357 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012358 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012359 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12360 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012361 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012362 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12363 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012364 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012365 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12366 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012367 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12368 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12369 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012370 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012371 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12372 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012373 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012374 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12375 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12376 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012377 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012378 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12379 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12380 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12381 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012382 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012383 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012384 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012385 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012386 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012387 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012388 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12389 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12390 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012391 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012392 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12393 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012394 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012395 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012396 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012397 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012398
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012399 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012400
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012401
124028.2.5. Error log format
12403-----------------------
12404
12405When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12406protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12407By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12408"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12409will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12410logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12411
12412The format looks like this :
12413
12414 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12415 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12416 Connection error during SSL handshake
12417
12418 Field Format Extract from the example above
12419 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12420 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12421 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12422 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12423 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12424
12425These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12426failures.
12427
12428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124298.3. Advanced logging options
12430-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012431
12432Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12433just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12434options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12435for more information about their usage.
12436
12437
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124388.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12439------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012440
12441It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12442haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12443commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12444monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12445ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12446
12447 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12448 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12449 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12450 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12451
12452 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12453 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12454 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012455 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012456 such as other load-balancers.
12457
12458 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12459 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12460 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12461
12462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124638.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12464----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012465
12466The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12467what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12468or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12469"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12470just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12471log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12472after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12473is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12474with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12475with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12476
12477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124788.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12479------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012480
12481Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12482for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12483"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12484retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12485raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12486a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12487file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12488you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12489"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12490
12491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12493--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012494
12495Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12496multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12497them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12498"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12499logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12500error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12501and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12502too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12503useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12504alternative.
12505
12506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125078.4. Timing events
12508------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012509
12510Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12511reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12512the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12513frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12514mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12515
12516 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12517 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12518 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12519 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12520 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12521
12522 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12523 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12524 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12525 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12526 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12527
12528 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12529 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12530 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12531 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12532 connection never established.
12533
12534 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12535 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12536 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12537 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12538 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12539 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12540 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12541 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12542 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12543 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12544 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12545
12546 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12547 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12548 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12549 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012550 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012551
12552 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12553
12554 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12555 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12556 negative.
12557
12558These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12559protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12560that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012561due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012562close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12563session has been aborted on timeout.
12564
12565Most common cases :
12566
12567 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12568 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12569 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12570 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12571 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12572 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12573 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12574 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12575 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012576 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12577 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12578 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012579
12580 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12581 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12582 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12583 of ms on remote networks.
12584
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012585 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12586 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12587 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012588
12589 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12590 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12591 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12592 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12593 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12594 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12595 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12596 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12597 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12598 to the server until another one is released.
12599
12600Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12601
12602 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12603 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12604 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12605
12606 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12607 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12608 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12609
12610 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12611 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12612 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12613 flags.
12614
12615 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12616 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12617 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12618 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12619 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12620 the client connection was maintained open.
12621
12622 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012623 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012624 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12625 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12626
12627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126288.5. Session state at disconnection
12629-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012630
12631TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12632"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
126332-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12634each of which has a special meaning :
12635
12636 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12637 session to terminate :
12638
12639 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12640
12641 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12642 server explicitly refused it.
12643
12644 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12645 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12646 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12647 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012648 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12649
12650 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12651 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012652
12653 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12654 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12655 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12656 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12657 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12658
12659 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12660 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12661 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12662 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12663 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12664
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012665 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12666 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12667
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012668 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12669 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12670 backup connections when going up.
12671
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012672 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12673
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012674 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12675 send or receive data.
12676
12677 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12678 send or receive data.
12679
12680 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12681 with nothing left in the buffers.
12682
12683 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12684
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012685 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012686 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12687
12688 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12689 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12690 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12691 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12692 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12693
12694 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12695 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12696
12697 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12698 server (HTTP only).
12699
12700 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12701
12702 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12703 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12704 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12705
12706 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12707 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12708 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12709
12710 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12711
12712 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12713 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12714
12715 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12716 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12717 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12718
12719 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12720 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012721 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12722 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012723
12724 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12725 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12726 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12727 another server.
12728
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012729 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012730 server.
12731
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012732 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12733 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12734 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12735 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12736
12737 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12738 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12739 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12740 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12741
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012742 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12743 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12744 "use-server" rule).
12745
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012746 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12747
12748 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12749 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12750
12751 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12752
12753 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12754 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12755 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12756
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012757 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12758 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012759 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012760 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12761 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12762
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012763 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12764
12765 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12766 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12767
12768 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12769
12770 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12771
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012772The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12773was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012774helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12775starvation, attacks, etc...
12776
12777The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12778alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12779easier finding and understanding.
12780
12781 Flags Reason
12782
12783 -- Normal termination.
12784
12785 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12786 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12787 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12788 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12789
12790 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12791 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12792 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12793 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12794 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12795 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012796
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012797 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12798 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012799 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012800
12801 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12802 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12803 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12804
12805 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12806 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12807 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12808 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12809 the server takes too long to respond.
12810
12811 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12812 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12813 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12814 long a time to respond.
12815
12816 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12817 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12818 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12819 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012820 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
12821 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012822
12823 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12824 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12825 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12826 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12827 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012828 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012829 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
12830 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
12831 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
12832 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
12833 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
12834 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
12835 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
12836 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
12837 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
12838 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
12839 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
12840 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012841
12842 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12843 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012844 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12845 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12846 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12847 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012848
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012849 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12850 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012852 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012853 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12854 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12855 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12856 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12857 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12858
12859 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12860 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12861 503 or 504 here.
12862
12863 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12864 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12865 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12866 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12867 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12868
12869 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12870 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012871 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012872 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12873 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12874
12875 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12876 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12877 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12878 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12879 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12880 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12881 between haproxy and the server.
12882
12883 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12884 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12885 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12886 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12887 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12888 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12889 solution is to fix the application.
12890
12891 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12892 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12893 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12894 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12895 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12896 external attacks.
12897
12898 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12899 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012900 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012901 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12902 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12903
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012904 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12905 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12906 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012907 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12908 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012909
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012910 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12911 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12912 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12913 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012914 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12915 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12916 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12917 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12918 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012919
12920 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12921 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12922 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12923 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12924
12925 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12926 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12927 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12928 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12929
12930 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12931 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12932 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12933 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12934
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012935The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12936persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12937important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12938re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12939
12940 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12941
12942 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12943 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12944 set on a GET request.
12945
12946 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12947 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012948 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012949 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12950
12951 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12952 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12953 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12954
12955 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12956 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12957 already got a cookie.
12958
12959 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12960 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12961 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12962 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12963 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12964
12965 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12966 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12967 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12968
12969 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12970 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12971 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12972
12973 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12974 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12975
12976 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12977 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12978 then advertised in the response.
12979
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129818.6. Non-printable characters
12982-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012983
12984In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12985consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12986converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12987prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12988being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12989escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12990is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12991'}' when logging headers.
12992
12993Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12994issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12995containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12996
12997Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12998the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12999performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13000
13001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13003---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013004
13005Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13006achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013007section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013008cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13009the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13010the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013011locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013012not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13013user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13014a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13015wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13016
13017 Examples :
13018 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13019 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13020
13021 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13022 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13023
13024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130258.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13026---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013027
13028Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13029proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13030the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13031server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13032
13033Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13034response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013035section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013036
13037It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013038time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13039appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013040are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13041and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13042follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13043request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13044in the logs.
13045
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013046As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13047frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13048an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13049
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013050 Example :
13051 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13052 listen proxy-out
13053 mode http
13054 option httplog
13055 option logasap
13056 log global
13057 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13058
13059 # log the name of the virtual server
13060 capture request header Host len 20
13061
13062 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13063 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13064
13065 # log the beginning of the referrer
13066 capture request header Referer len 20
13067
13068 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13069 capture response header Server len 20
13070
13071 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13072 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13073
13074 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13075 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13076
13077 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13078 capture response header Via len 20
13079
13080 # log the URL location during a redirection
13081 capture response header Location len 20
13082
13083 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13084 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13085 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13086 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13087 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13088
13089 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13090 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13091 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13092 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013093 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013094
13095 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13096 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13097 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13098 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13099 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013100 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013101
13102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131038.9. Examples of logs
13104---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013105
13106These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13107them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13108reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13109
13110 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13111 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13112 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13113
13114 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13115 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13116
13117 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13118 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13119 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13120
13121 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13122 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13123
13124 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13125 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13126 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13127
13128 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013129 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013130 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13131 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13132
13133 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13134 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13135 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13136
13137 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13138 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013139 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013140 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13141 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13142 to return the 502 and not the server.
13143
13144 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013145 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013146
13147 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13148 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13149 Nothing was sent to any server.
13150
13151 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13152 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13153
13154 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13155 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13156 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13157 send a 408 return code to the client.
13158
13159 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13160 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13161
13162 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13163 5 seconds ("c----").
13164
13165 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13166 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013167 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013168
13169 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013170 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013171 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13172 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13173 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13174 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13175 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013176
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131789. Statistics and monitoring
13179----------------------------
13180
13181It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13182mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13183CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13184Unix socket.
13185
13186
131879.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013188---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013189
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013190The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013191page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13192begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13193represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13194use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13195('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13196(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13197text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13198do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13199use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013200
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013201In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13202that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13203S (Servers).
13204
13205 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13206 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13207 any name for server/listener)
13208 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13209 number queued without a server assigned.
13210 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13211 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13212 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13213 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13214 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13215 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13216 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13217 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13218 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13219 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13220 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13221 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13222 "option checkcache".
13223 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13224 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13225 - read error from the client
13226 - client timeout
13227 - client closed connection
13228 - various bad requests from the client.
13229 - request was tarpitted.
13230 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13231 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13232 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13233 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13234 active servers).
13235 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13236 Some other errors are:
13237 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13238 - failure applying filters to the response.
13239 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13240 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13241 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13242 switched away from.
13243 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissisac372e12015-05-02 20:30:44 +020013244 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
13245 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
13246 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013247 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13248 the server is up.)
13249 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13250 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13251 counters for each server.
13252 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13253 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13254 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13255 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13256 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13257 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13258 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13259 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13260 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13261 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13262 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13263 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13264 of times that server was selected.
13265 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13266 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13267 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13268 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13269 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13270 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013271 UNK -> unknown
13272 INI -> initializing
13273 SOCKERR -> socket error
13274 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harveycac41222015-04-16 11:13:21 -080013275 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013276 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13277 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13278 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13279 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13280 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13281 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13282 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13283 disable-on-404
13284 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13285 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13286 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013287 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13288 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13289 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13290 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13291 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13292 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13293 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13294 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13295 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13296 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13297 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13298 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13299 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13300 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13301 (inc. in eresp)
13302 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13303 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13304 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13305 (CPU/BW limit)
13306 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13307 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13308 server/backend
13309 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13310 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13311 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13312 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13313 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13314 (0 for TCP)
13315 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13316 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013317
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133199.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013320-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013321
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013322The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13323necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13324A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13325issuing commands by hand :
13326
13327 global
13328 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13329 stats timeout 2m
13330
13331It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13332the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13333never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13334situations :
13335
13336 global
13337 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13338 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13339 stats timeout 2m
13340
13341To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13342swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13343to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13344syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13345
13346 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13347 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13348
13349The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13350script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13351for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13352
13353The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13354that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13355editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13356(eg: watch a counter).
13357
13358The socket supports two operation modes :
13359 - interactive
13360 - non-interactive
13361
13362The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13363this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13364sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13365mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13366commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13367example :
13368
13369 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13370
13371The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13372entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13373for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13374sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13375"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13376after processing the last command of the same line.
13377
13378For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13379"prompt" command :
13380
13381 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13382 prompt
13383 > show info
13384 ...
13385 >
13386
13387Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13388delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13389that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13390parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013391
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013392It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13393on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13394own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013395
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013396The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13397If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13398all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13399it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13400
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013401add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013402 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13403 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13404 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13405 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013406
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013407add map <map> <key> <value>
13408 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13409 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013410 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13411 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13412 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013413
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013414clear counters
13415 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13416 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13417 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13418 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13419 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13420
13421clear counters all
13422 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13423 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13424 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13425
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013426clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013427 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13428 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13429 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013430
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013431clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013432 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13433 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13434 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013435
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013436clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13437 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13438
13439 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13440 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13441 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13442 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13443 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13444 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13445
13446 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13447
13448 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13449 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13450 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13451 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13452 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13453 the ACLs :
13454
13455 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13456 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13457 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13458 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13459 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13460 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13461
13462 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013463 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13464 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013465
13466 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013467 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013468 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013469 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13470 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13471 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13472 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013473
13474 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13475
13476 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013477 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013478 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13479 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013480 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13481 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13482 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013483
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013484del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13485 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013486 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13487 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13488 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13489 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013490
13491del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013492 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013493 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13494 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13495 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13496 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013497
13498disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013499 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13500
13501 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13502 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13503 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13504 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13505 re-enabled using enable agent.
13506
13507 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13508 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13509 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13510 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13511 otherwise unchanged.
13512
13513 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13514 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13515 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13516
13517 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13518 level "admin".
13519
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013520disable frontend <frontend>
13521 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13522 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13523 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13524 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13525 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13526 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13527 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13528 on the stats page.
13529
13530 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13531 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13532
13533 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13534 level "admin".
13535
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013536disable health <backend>/<server>
13537 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13538 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13539 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13540 agent check forces it down.
13541
13542 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13543 level "admin".
13544
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013545disable server <backend>/<server>
13546 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13547 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13548 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13549 during the maintenance.
13550
13551 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13552 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13553
13554 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013555 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013556
13557 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13558 level "admin".
13559
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013560enable agent <backend>/<server>
13561 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13562
13563 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13564 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13565
13566 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13567 level "admin".
13568
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013569enable frontend <frontend>
13570 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13571 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13572 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13573 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13574 which was disabled.
13575
13576 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13577 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13578
13579 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13580 level "admin".
13581
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013582enable health <backend>/<server>
13583 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13584 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13585
13586 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13587 level "admin".
13588
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013589enable server <backend>/<server>
13590 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13591 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13592
13593 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013594 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013595
13596 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13597 level "admin".
13598
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013599get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013600get acl <acl> <value>
13601 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13602 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13603 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13604 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13605 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013606
13607 The first two words are:
13608
13609 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13610 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13611 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13612
13613 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13614
13615 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13616
13617 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13618
13619 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13620 interpretation of the case.
13621
13622 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13623 useful with regular expressions.
13624
13625 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13626 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13627
13628 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13629 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13630 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13631
13632 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13633
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013634get weight <backend>/<server>
13635 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13636 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13637 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13638 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13639 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013640 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013641
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013642help
13643 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13644 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013645
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013646prompt
13647 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13648 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13649 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13650 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13651 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13652 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13653 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13654 command.
13655
13656quit
13657 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013658
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013659set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013660 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13661 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13662 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013663
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013664set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013665 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13666 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13667 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13668 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13669 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013670 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13671 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13672
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013673set maxconn global <maxconn>
13674 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13675 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13676 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13677 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13678 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13679 setting.
13680
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013681set rate-limit connections global <value>
13682 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13683 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13684 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13685 is passed in number of connections per second.
13686
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013687set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13688 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13689 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013690 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13691 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013692
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013693set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13694 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13695 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13696 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13697 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13698
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013699set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13700 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13701 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13702 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13703 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13704 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13705
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013706set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13707 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13708 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13709 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13710
13711set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13712 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13713 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13714 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13715
13716set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13717 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13718 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13719 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13720 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13721 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13722 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13723 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13724 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13725
13726set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13727 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13728 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13729
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013730set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13731 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13732 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13733 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13734 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13735
13736 Example:
13737 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13738 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13739 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13740 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13741
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013742set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013743 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13744 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13745 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13746 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013747 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13748 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013749
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013750set timeout cli <delay>
13751 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13752 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13753 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13754
13755set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13756 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13757 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013758 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13759 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13760 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13761 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13762 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13763 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13764 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13765 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13766 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13767 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13768 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13769 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13770 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013771
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013772show errors [<iid>]
13773 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13774 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013775 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13776 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13777 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013778
13779 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13780 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13781 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13782 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13783 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13784 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13785 are reported too.
13786
13787 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13788 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13789 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13790 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13791 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13792 code.
13793
13794 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13795 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13796 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13797 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13798 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13799 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13800 line.
13801
13802 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013803 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13804 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013805 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13806 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13807
13808 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13809 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13810 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13811 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13812 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13813 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13814 00204+ minal\r\n
13815 00211 \r\n
13816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013817 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013818 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13819 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13820 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13821 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13822 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13823 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013824
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013825show info
13826 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13827
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013828show map [<map>]
13829 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013830 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13831 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13832 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13833 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13834 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13835 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013836
13837show acl [<acl>]
13838 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013839 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13840 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13841 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13842 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13843 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013844
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013845show pools
13846 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13847 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13848 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13849 the pools.
13850
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013851show sess
13852 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013853 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13854 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13855
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013856show sess <id>
13857 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13858 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13859 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13860 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13861 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Oliviere99d44d2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020013862 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
13863 returned in src/dumpstats.c
13864
13865 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
13866 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013867
13868show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13869 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13870 possible to dump only selected items :
13871 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13872 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13873 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13874 for example:
13875 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13876 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13877 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13878
13879 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013880 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13881 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013882 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13883 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13884 Nbproc: 1
13885 Process_num: 1
13886 (...)
13887
13888 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13889 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13890 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13891 (...)
13892 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13893
13894 $
13895
13896 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13897 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13898 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13899 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013900 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013901
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013902show table
13903 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13904 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13905 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13906 entries currently in use.
13907
13908 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013909 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013910 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13911 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013912
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013913show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013914 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13915 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13916 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013917 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13918
13919 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13920 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13921 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13922 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13923 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13924
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013925 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13926 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13927 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13928 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13929 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13930 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13931
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013932
13933 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013934 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13935 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013936
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013937 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013938 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013939 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013940 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13941 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13942 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13943 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013944
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013945 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013946 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013947 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13948 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013949
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013950 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13951 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013952 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013953 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13954 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013955
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013956 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13957 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013958 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013959 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13960 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13961
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013962 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13963 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13964 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13965 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13966 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13967
13968 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13969 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13970 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013971 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13972 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013973 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13974 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013975
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013976shutdown frontend <frontend>
13977 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13978 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13979 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13980 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13981 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13982 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13983 once it is terminated.
13984
13985 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13986 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13987
13988 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13989 level "admin".
13990
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013991shutdown session <id>
13992 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13993 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13994 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13995 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13996 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13997 flag in the logs.
13998
Cyril Bontéde9789b2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020013999shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014000 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14001 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14002 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14003 'K' flag in the logs.
14004
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014005/*
14006 * Local variables:
14007 * fill-column: 79
14008 * End:
14009 */